US20090176822A1 - Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap - Google Patents

Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20090176822A1
US20090176822A1 US12/105,109 US10510908A US2009176822A1 US 20090176822 A1 US20090176822 A1 US 20090176822A1 US 10510908 A US10510908 A US 10510908A US 2009176822 A1 US2009176822 A1 US 2009176822A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
mmol
alkyl
heterocycle
mixture
compound
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US12/105,109
Inventor
Frederick Cohen
Vickie Hsiao-Wei Tsui
Cuong Ly
John A. Flygare
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Genentech Inc
Original Assignee
Genentech Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Family has litigation
First worldwide family litigation filed litigation Critical https://patents.darts-ip.com/?family=36129810&utm_source=google_patent&utm_medium=platform_link&utm_campaign=public_patent_search&patent=US20090176822(A1) "Global patent litigation dataset” by Darts-ip is licensed under a Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 International License.
Application filed by Genentech Inc filed Critical Genentech Inc
Priority to US12/105,109 priority Critical patent/US20090176822A1/en
Publication of US20090176822A1 publication Critical patent/US20090176822A1/en
Priority to US12/538,794 priority patent/US8609845B2/en
Priority to US14/088,110 priority patent/US9040706B2/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D471/00Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
    • C07D471/02Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D471/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/41Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having five-membered rings with two or more ring hetero atoms, at least one of which being nitrogen, e.g. tetrazole
    • A61K31/425Thiazoles
    • A61K31/427Thiazoles not condensed and containing further heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D417/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00
    • C07D417/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing two hetero rings
    • C07D417/04Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing two hetero rings directly linked by a ring-member-to-ring-member bond
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D417/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00
    • C07D417/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing three or more hetero rings

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to organic compounds useful for therapy and/or prophylaxis in a mammal, and in particular to inhibitors of IAP proteins useful for treating cancers.
  • Apoptosis or programmed cell death is a genetically and biochemically regulated mechanism that plays an important role in development and homeostasis in invertebrates as well as vertebrates. Aberrancies in apoptosis that lead to premature cell death have been linked to a variety of developmental disorders. Deficiencies in apoptosis that result in the lack of cell death have been linked to cancer and chronic viral infections (Thompson et al., (1995) Science 267, 1456-1462).
  • caspases cyste containing aspartate specific proteases
  • Caspases are strong proteases, cleaving after aspartic acid residues and once activated, digest vital cell proteins from within the cell. Since caspases are such strong proteases, tight control of this family of proteins is necessary to prevent premature cell death.
  • caspases are synthesized as largely inactive zymogens that require proteolytic processing in order to be active. This proteolytic processing is only one of the ways in which caspases are regulated. The second mechanism is through a family of proteins that bind and inhibit caspases.
  • IAP Inhibitors of Apoptosis
  • IAPs were originally discovered in baculovirus by their functional ability to substitute for P35 protein, an anti-apoptotic gene (Crook et al. (1993) J Virology 67, 2168-2174). IAPs have been described in organisms ranging from Drosophila to human. Regardless of their origin, structurally, IAPs comprise one to three Baculovirus IAP repeat (BIR) domains, and most of them also possess a carboxyl-terminal RING finger motif.
  • BIR Baculovirus IAP repeat
  • the BIR domain itself is a zinc binding domain of about 70 residues comprising 4 alpha-helices and 3 beta strands, with cysteine and histidine residues that coordinate the zinc ion (Hinds et al., (1999) Nat. Struct. Biol. 6, 648-651). It is the BIR domain that is believed to cause the anti-apoptotic effect by inhibiting the caspases and thus inhibiting apoptosis.
  • human X-chromosome linked IAP XIAP
  • inhibits caspase 3, caspase 7 and the Apaf-1-cytochrome C mediated activation of caspase 9 (Deveraux et al., (1998) EMBO J. 17, 2215-2223).
  • Caspases 3 and 7 are inhibited by the BIR2 domain of XIAP, while the BIR3 domain of XIAP is responsible for the inhibition of caspase 9 activity.
  • XIAP is expressed ubiquitously in most adult and fetal tissues (Liston et al, Nature, 1996, 379(6563):349), and is overexpressed in a number of tumor cell lines of the NCI 60 cell line panel (Fong et al, Genomics, 2000, 70:113; Tamm et al, Clin. Cancer Res. 2000, 6(5):1796).
  • ML-IAP Melanoma IAP
  • BIR domain of ML-IAP appears to have the most similarities to the BIR2 and BIR3 of XIAP, C-IAP1 and C-IAP2, and appears to be responsible for the inhibition of apoptosis, as determined by deletional analysis.
  • ML-IAP could inhibit chemotherapeutic agent induced apoptosis.
  • Agents such as adriamycin and 4-tertiary butylphenol (4-TBP) were tested in a cell culture system of melanomas overexpressing ML-IAP and the chemotherapeutic agents were significantly less effective in killing the cells when compared to a normal melanocyte control.
  • the mechanism by which ML-IAP produces an anti-apoptotic activity is in part through inhibition of caspase 3 and 9. ML-IAP did not effectively inhibit caspases 1, 2, 6, or 8.
  • novel inhibitors of IAP proteins having the general formula I:
  • compositions comprising compounds of formula I and a carrier, diluent or excipient.
  • a method of inducing apoptosis in a cell comprising introducing into said cell a compound of formula I.
  • a method of sensitizing a cell to an apoptotic signal comprising introducing into said cell a compound of formula I.
  • a method for inhibiting the binding of an IAP protein to a caspase protein comprising contacting said IAP protein with a compound of formula I.
  • a method for treating a disease or condition associated with the overexpression of an IAP protein in a mammal comprising administering to said mammal an effective amount of a compound of formula I.
  • Acyl means a carbonyl containing substituent represented by the formula —C(O)—R in which R is H, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle, carbocycle-substituted alkyl or heterocycle-substituted alkyl wherein the alkyl, alkoxy, carbocycle and heterocycle are as defined herein.
  • Acyl groups include alkanoyl (e.g. acetyl), aroyl (e.g. benzoyl), and heteroaroyl.
  • Alkyl means a branched or unbranched, saturated or unsaturated (i.e. alkenyl, alkynyl) aliphatic hydrocarbon group, having up to 12 carbon atoms unless otherwise specified.
  • alkylamino the alkyl portion may be a saturated hydrocarbon chain, however also includes unsaturated hydrocarbon carbon chains such as “alkenylamino” and “alkynylamino.
  • alkyl groups are methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, n-pentyl, 2-methylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, n-hexyl, 2-methylpentyl, 2,2-dimethylbutyl, n-heptyl, 3-heptyl, 2-methylhexyl, and the like.
  • lower alkyl C 1 -C 4 alkyl and “alkyl of 1 to 4 carbon atoms” are synonymous and used interchangeably to mean methyl, ethyl, 1-propyl, isopropyl, cyclopropyl, 1-butyl, sec-butyl or t-butyl.
  • substituted, alkyl groups may contain one, for example two, three or four substituents which may be the same or different.
  • substituents are, unless otherwise defined, halogen, amino, hydroxyl, protected hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxy, alkoxy, nitro, cyano, amidino, guanidino, urea, sulfonyl, sulfinyl, aminosulfonyl, alkylsulfonylamino, arylsulfonylamino, aminocarbonyl, acylamino, alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, a carbocycle, a heterocycle.
  • Examples of the above substituted alkyl groups include, but are not limited to; cyanomethyl, nitromethyl, hydroxymethyl, trityloxymethyl, propionyloxymethyl, aminomethyl, carboxymethyl, carboxyethyl, carboxypropyl, alkyloxycarbonylmethyl, allyloxycarbonylaminomethyl, carbamoyloxymethyl, methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, t-butoxymethyl, acetoxymethyl, chloromethyl, bromomethyl, iodomethyl, trifluoromethyl, 6-hydroxyhexyl, 2,4-dichloro(n-butyl), 2-amino(iso-propyl), 2-carbamoyloxyethyl and the like.
  • the alkyl group may also be substituted with a carbocycle group.
  • Examples include cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, and cyclohexylmethyl groups, as well as the corresponding-ethyl, -propyl, -butyl, -pentyl, -hexyl groups, etc.
  • Substituted alkyls include substituted methyls e.g. a methyl group substituted by the same substituents as the “substituted C n -C m alkyl” group.
  • Examples of the substituted methyl group include groups such as hydroxymethyl, protected hydroxymethyl (e.g. tetrahydropyranyloxymethyl), acetoxymethyl, carbamoyloxymethyl, trifluoromethyl, chloromethyl, carboxymethyl, bromomethyl and iodomethyl.
  • Amidine means the group —C(NH)—NHR wherein R is H or alkyl or aralkyl. A particular amidine is the group —NH—C(NH)—NH 2 .
  • Amino means primary (i.e. —NH 2 ), secondary (i.e. —NRH) and tertiary (i.e. —NRR) amines.
  • Particular secondary and tertiary amines are alkylamine, dialkylamine, arylamine, diarylamine, aralkylamine and diaralkylamine wherein the alkyl is as herein defined and optionally substituted.
  • Particular secondary and tertiary amines are methylamine, ethylamine, propylamine, isopropylamine, phenylamine, benzylamine dimethylamine, diethylamine, dipropylamine and disopropylamine.
  • “Amino-protecting group” refers to a derivative of the groups commonly employed to block or protect an amino group while reactions are carried out on other functional groups on the compound.
  • protecting groups include carbamates, amides, alkyl and aryl groups, imines, as well as many N-heteroatom derivatives which can be removed to regenerate the desired amine group.
  • Particular amino protecting groups are Boc, Fmoc and Cbz. Further examples of these groups are found in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, 2 nd ed., John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1991, chapter 7; E.
  • protected amino refers to an amino group substituted with one of the above amino-protecting groups.
  • Aryl when used alone or as part of another term means a carbocyclic aromatic group whether or not fused having the number of carbon atoms designated or if no number is designated, up to 14 carbon atoms.
  • Particular aryl groups are phenyl, naphthyl, biphenyl, phenanthrenyl, naphthacenyl, and the like (see e.g. Lang's Handbook of Chemistry (Dean, J. A., ed) 13 th ed. Table 7-2 [1985]).
  • a particular aryl is phenyl.
  • Substituted phenyl or substituted aryl means a phenyl group or aryl group substituted with one, two, three, four or five, for example 1-2, 1-3 or 1-4 substituents chosen, unless otherwise specified, from halogen (F, Cl, Br, I), hydroxy, protected hydroxy, cyano, nitro, alkyl (for example C 1 -C 6 alkyl), alkoxy (for example C 1 -C 6 alkoxy), benzyloxy, carboxy, protected carboxy, carboxymethyl, protected carboxymethyl, hydroxymethyl, protected hydroxymethyl, aminomethyl, protected aminomethyl, trifluoromethyl, alkylsulfonylamino, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, arylsulfonylamino, arylsulonylaminoalkyl, heterocyclylsulfonylamino, heterocyclylsulfonylaminoalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl
  • substituted phenyl includes but is not limited to a mono- or di(halo)phenyl group such as 2-chlorophenyl, 2-bromophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2,6-dichlorophenyl, 2,5-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-bromophenyl, 4-bromophenyl, 3,4-dibromophenyl, 3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl and the like; a mono- or di(hydroxy)phenyl group such as 4-hydroxyphenyl, 3-hydroxyphenyl, 2,4-dihydroxyphenyl, the protected-hydroxy derivatives thereof and the like; a nitrophenyl
  • substituted phenyl represents disubstituted phenyl groups where the substituents are different, for example, 3-methyl-4-hydroxyphenyl, 3-chloro-4-hydroxyphenyl, 2-methoxy-4-bromophenyl, 4-ethyl-2-hydroxyphenyl, 3-hydroxy-4-nitrophenyl, 2-hydroxy-4-chlorophenyl, and the like, as well as trisubstituted phenyl groups where the substituents are different, for example 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxy-6-methyl sulfonylamino, 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxy-6-phenyl sulfonylamino, and tetrasubstituted phenyl groups where the substituents are different such as 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxy-5-methyl-6-phenyl sulfonylamino.
  • Particular substituted phenyl groups include the 2-chlorophenyl, 2-aminophenyl, 2-bromophenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxy-phenyl, 4-benzyloxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxy-4-benzyloxyphenyl, 3,4-diethoxyphenyl, 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxyphenyl, 3-methoxy-4-(1-chloromethyl)benzyloxy-phenyl, 3-methoxy-4-(1-chloromethyl)benzyloxy-6-methyl sulfonyl aminophenyl groups.
  • Fused aryl rings may also be substituted with any, for example 1, 2 or 3, of the substituents specified herein in the same manner as substituted alkyl groups.
  • Carbocyclyl “carbocyclylic”, “carbocycle” and “carbocyclo” alone and when used as a moiety in a complex group such as a carbocycloalkyl group, refers to a mono-, bi-, or tricyclic aliphatic ring having 3 to 14 carbon atoms, for example 3 to 7 carbon atoms, which may be saturated or unsaturated, aromatic or non-aromatic.
  • Particular saturated carbocyclic groups are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl groups.
  • a particular saturated carbocycle is cyclopropyl.
  • Another particular saturated carbocycle is cyclohexyl.
  • Particular unsaturated carbocycles are aromatic e.g. aryl groups as previously defined, for example phenyl.
  • the terms “substituted carbocyclyl”, “carbocycle” and “carbocyclo” mean these groups substituted by the same substituents as the “substituted alkyl” group.
  • Carboxy-protecting group refers to one of the ester derivatives of the carboxylic acid group commonly employed to block or protect the carboxylic acid group while reactions are carried out on other functional groups on the compound.
  • carboxylic acid protecting groups include 4-nitrobenzyl, 4-methoxybenzyl, 3,4-dimethoxybenzyl, 2,4-dimethoxybenzyl, 2,4,6-trimethoxybenzyl, 2,4,6-trimethylbenzyl, pentamethylbenzyl, 3,4-methylenedioxybenzyl, benzhydryl, 4,4′-dimethoxybenzhydryl, 2,2′,4,4′-tetramethoxybenzhydryl, alkyl such as t-butyl or t-amyl, trityl, 4-methoxytrityl, 4,4′-dimethoxytrityl, 4,4′,4′′-trimethoxytrityl, 2-phenylprop-2-yl, trimethyl
  • carboxy-protecting group employed is not critical so long as the derivatized carboxylic acid is stable to the condition of subsequent reaction(s) on other positions of the molecule and can be removed at the appropriate point without disrupting the remainder of the molecule.
  • it is important not to subject a carboxy-protected molecule to strong nucleophilic bases, such as lithium hydroxide or NaOH, or reductive conditions employing highly activated metal hydrides such as LiAlH 4 . (Such harsh removal conditions are also to be avoided when removing amino-protecting groups and hydroxy-protecting groups, discussed below.)
  • Particular carboxylic acid protecting groups are the alkyl (e.g.
  • protected carboxy refers to a carboxy group substituted with one of the above carboxy-protecting groups.
  • guanidine means the group —NH—C(NH)—NHR wherein R is H or alkyl or aralkyl.
  • R is H or alkyl or aralkyl.
  • a particular guanidine is the group —NH—C(NH)—NH 2 .
  • “Hydroxy-protecting group” refers to a derivative of the hydroxy group commonly employed to block or protect the hydroxy group while reactions are carried out on other functional groups on the compound.
  • protecting groups include tetrahydropyranyloxy, benzoyl, acetoxy, carbamoyloxy, benzyl, and silylethers (e.g. TBS, TBDPS) groups. Further examples of these groups are found in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, 2 nd ed., John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1991, chapters 2-3; E.
  • protected hydroxy refers to a hydroxy group substituted with one of the above hydroxy-protecting groups.
  • Heterocyclic group “heterocyclic”, “heterocycle”, “heterocyclyl”, or “heterocyclo” alone and when used as a moiety in a complex group such as a heterocycloalkyl group, are used interchangeably and refer to any mono-, bi-, or tricyclic, saturated or unsaturated, aromatic (heteroaryl) or non-aromatic ring having the number of atoms designated, generally from 5 to about 14 ring atoms, where the ring atoms are carbon and at least one heteroatom (nitrogen, sulfur or oxygen), for example 1 to 4 heteroatoms.
  • a 5-membered ring has 0 to 2 double bonds and 6- or 7-membered ring has 0 to 3 double bonds and the nitrogen or sulfur heteroatoms may optionally be oxidized (e.g. SO, SO 2 ), and any nitrogen heteroatom may optionally be quaternized.
  • non-aromatic heterocycles are morpholinyl (morpholino), pyrrolidinyl, oxiranyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 2,3-dihydrofuranyl, 2H-pyranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, thiiranyl, thietanyl, tetrahydrothietanyl, aziridinyl, azetidinyl, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolyl, piperazinyl and piperidinyl.
  • a “heterocycloalkyl” group is a heterocycle group as defined above covalently bonded to an alkyl group as defined above.
  • Particular 5-membered heterocycles containing a sulfur or oxygen atom and one to three nitrogen atoms are thiazolyl, in particular thiazol-2-yl and thiazol-2-yl N-oxide, thiadiazolyl, in particular 1,3,4-thiadiazol-5-yl and 1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, oxazolyl, for example oxazol-2-yl, and oxadiazolyl, such as 1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, and 1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl.
  • Particular 5-membered ring heterocycles containing 2 to 4 nitrogen atoms include imidazolyl, such as imidazol-2-yl; triazolyl, such as 1,3,4-triazol-5-yl; 1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 1,2,4-triazol-5-yl, and tetrazolyl, such as 1H-tetrazol-5-yl.
  • Particular benzo-fused 5-membered heterocycles are benzoxazol-2-yl, benzthiazol-2-yl and benzimidazol-2-yl.
  • Particular 6-membered heterocycles contain one to three nitrogen atoms and optionally a sulfur or oxygen atom, for example pyridyl, such as pyrid-2-yl, pyrid-3-yl, and pyrid-4-yl; pyrimidyl, such as pyrimid-2-yl and pyrimid-4-yl; triazinyl, such as 1,3,4-triazin-2-yl and 1,3,5-triazin-4-yl; pyridazinyl, in particular pyridazin-3-yl, and pyrazinyl.
  • pyridyl such as pyrid-2-yl, pyrid-3-yl, and pyrid-4-yl
  • pyrimidyl such as pyrimid-2-yl and pyrimid-4-yl
  • triazinyl such as 1,3,4-triazin-2-yl and 1,3,5-triazin-4-yl
  • pyridine N-oxides and pyridazine N-oxides and the pyridyl, pyrimid-2-yl, pyrimid-4-yl, pyridazinyl and the 1,3,4-triazin-2-yl groups are a particular group.
  • Substituents for “optionally substituted heterocycles”, and further examples of the 5- and 6-membered ring systems discussed above can be found in W. Druckheimer et al, U.S. Pat. No. 4,278,793.
  • such optionally substituted heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino.
  • Heteroaryl alone and when used as a moiety in a complex group such as a heteroaralkyl group, refers to any mono-, bi-, or tricyclic aromatic ring system having the number of atoms designated where at least one ring is a 5-, 6- or 7-membered ring containing from one to four heteroatoms selected from the group nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, and in a particular embodiment at least one heteroatom is nitrogen ( Lang's Handbook of Chemistry , supra). Included in the definition are any bicyclic groups where any of the above heteroaryl rings are fused to a benzene ring. Particular heteroaryls incorporate a nitrogen or oxygen heteroatom.
  • heteroaryl whether substituted or unsubstituted groups denoted by the term “heteroaryl”: thienyl, furyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, triazolyl, thiadiazolyl, oxadiazolyl, tetrazolyl, thiatriazolyl, oxatriazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, thiazinyl, oxazinyl, triazinyl, thiadiazinyl, oxadiazinyl, dithiazinyl, dioxazinyl, oxathiazinyl, tetrazinyl, thiatriazinyl, oxatriazinyl, dithiadiazinyl
  • a particular “heteroaryl” is: 1,3-thiazol-2-yl, 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl, 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl sodium salt, 1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 3-methyl-1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-hydroxy-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-carboxy-4-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl sodium salt, 2-carboxy-4-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 1,3-oxazol-2-yl, 1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 2-(hydroxymethyl)-1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 1,3,
  • heteroaryl includes; 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl, 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl sodium salt, 1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-methyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(1-(dimethylamino)eth-2-yl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(carboxymethyl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(carboxymethyl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl sodium salt, 1-(methylsulfonic acid)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(methylsulfonic acid)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl sodium salt, 1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 1,4,5,6-tetrahydro-5,6-di
  • “Inhibitor” means a compound which reduces or prevents the binding of IAP proteins to caspase proteins or which reduces or prevents the inhibition of apoptosis by an IAP protein.
  • “inhibitor” means a compound which prevents the binding interaction of X-IAP with caspases or the binding interaction of ML-IAP with SMAC.
  • Optionally substituted unless otherwise specified means that a group may be substituted by one or more (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4) of the substituents listed for that group in which said substituents may be the same or different. In an embodiment an optionally substituted group has 1 substituent. In another embodiment an optionally substituted group has 2 substituents. In another embodiment an optionally substituted group has 3 substituents.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable salts” include both acid and base addition salts.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salt” refers to those salts which retain the biological effectiveness and properties of the free bases and which are not biologically or otherwise undesirable, formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, carbonic acid, phosphoric acid and the like, and organic acids may be selected from aliphatic, cycloaliphatic, aromatic, araliphatic, heterocyclic, carboxylic, and sulfonic classes of organic acids such as formic acid, acetic acid, propionic acid, glycolic acid, gluconic acid, lactic acid, pyruvic acid, oxalic acid, malic acid, maleic acid, maloneic acid, succinic acid, fumaric acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, aspartic acid, ascorbic acid, glutamic acid, anthranilic acid, benzoic acid, cinnamic acid
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts” include those derived from inorganic bases such as sodium, potassium, lithium, ammonium, calcium, magnesium, iron, zinc, copper, manganese, aluminum salts and the like. Particularly base addition salts are the ammonium, potassium, sodium, calcium and magnesium salts.
  • Salts derived from pharmaceutically acceptable organic nontoxic bases includes salts of primary, secondary, and tertiary amines, substituted amines including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines and basic ion exchange resins, such as isopropylamine, trimethylamine, diethylamine, triethylamine, tripropylamine, ethanolamine, 2-diethylaminoethanol, trimethamine, dicyclohexylamine, lysine, arginine, histidine, caffeine, procaine, hydrabamine, choline, betaine, ethylenediamine, glucosamine, methylglucamine, theobromine, purines, piperizine, piperidine, N-ethylpiperidine, polyamine resins and the like.
  • Particularly organic non-toxic bases are isopropylamine, diethylamine, ethanolamine, trimethamine, dicyclohexylamine, choline, and caffeine.
  • “Sulfonyl” means a —SO 2 —R group wherein R is alkyl, carbocycle, heterocycle, carbocycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl.
  • Particular sulfonyl groups are alkylsulfonyl (i.e. —SO 2 -alkyl), for example methylsulfonyl; arylsulfonyl, for example phenylsulfonyl; aralkylsulfonyl, for example benzylsulfonyl.
  • salts and solvates thereof as used herein means that compounds of the inventions may exist in one or a mixture of salts and solvate forms.
  • a compound of the invention may be substantially pure in one particular salt or solvate form or else may be mixtures of two or more salt or solvate forms.
  • the present invention provides novel compounds having the general formula I:
  • Ring A is a 5-member aromatic heterocycle incorporating 1 to 4 heteroatoms N, O or S which is substituted with group Q and is optionally further substituted with one or more R 7 (for substitutions at a ring carbon atom) and one or more R 8 (for substitutions at a ring nitrogen).
  • R 7 in each occurrence is independently H, cyano, hydroxyl, mercapto, halogen, nitro, carboxyl, amidino, guanidino, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle or —U—V; wherein U is —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O) 2 , —N(R 8 )—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—, —SO 2 —NR 8 —, —NR 8 —SO 2 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)— and V is alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; and wherein one or more CH 2 or CH groups of an alky
  • Substituents of the “optionally substituted carbocycle” and “optionally substituted heterocycle” are as defined herein.
  • such carbocycle and heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino.
  • R 7 is H, halogen, cyano, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl or alkoxyalkyl.
  • R 8 is H, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle wherein one or more CH 2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O) 2 , —N(R 8 ), or —C(O)—; and said alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo ( ⁇ O), carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle.
  • Substituents of the “optionally substituted carbocycle” and “optionally substituted heterocycle” are as defined herein.
  • such carbocycle and heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino.
  • R 8 is H, alkyl, or acyl.
  • R 8 is methyl.
  • R 8 is acetyl.
  • R 8 is H.
  • R 7 is H, halogen, amino, hydroxyl, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl or aralkyl.
  • R 7 is halogen, for example Cl or F.
  • R 7 is H. It is understood that substitutions defined for R 7 and R 8 as well as all other variable groups herein are subject to permissible valency.
  • Z 1 is NR 8 , O or S; and Z 2 , Z 3 and Z 4 are each independently N or CR 7 .
  • Group Q is attached to ring A of formula II and II′ at the ring member between Z 2 and Z 3 .
  • Z 1 is S.
  • Z 1 is O.
  • Z 1 is NR 8 wherein R 8 is as defined herein.
  • Z 1 is NR 8 wherein R 8 is H.
  • Z 1 is NR 8 wherein R 8 is Me.
  • Z 1 is O or S while Z 2 is N and Z 3 is N or CR 7 .
  • Z 1 is S while Z 2 is N and Z 3 is CR 7 .
  • Z 1 is S while Z 2 is N and Z 3 is CR 7 .
  • Z 1 is S while Z 2 is N and Z 3 is CH.
  • ring A is an aromatic heterocyle selected from the group consisting of IIa-IIcc:
  • R 7 and R 8 are as defined herein.
  • Q is not part of ring A and is shown for positional purposes.
  • ring A is any one of the groups IIa-IIz wherein R 8 is H and R 7 is H, Cl, or hydroxypropynyl.
  • ring A is any one of the groups IIa-IIz wherein R 7 and R 8 are both H.
  • ring A is the IIg.
  • ring A is IIg and R 7 is H.
  • Q is H, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH 2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O) 2 , —N(R 9 )—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—, —SO 2 —NR 8 —, —NR 8 —SO 2 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and wherein any of the foregoing alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl,
  • Substituents of the “optionally substituted carbocycle” and “optionally substituted heterocycle” are as defined herein.
  • such carbocycle and heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino.
  • Q is a carbocycle or heterocycle optionally substituted with halogen, amino, oxo, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH 2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O) 2 , —N(R 8 )—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—, —SO 2 —NR 8 —, —NR 8 —SO 2 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and wherein said alkyl, carbocycle or heterocycle is optionally substituted with halogen, amino, hydroxyl, mercapto, carb
  • Q is a carbocycle or heterocycle selected from the group consisting of IIIa-IIIs:
  • n is 1-4, for example 1-3, for example 1-2, for example 1; T is O, S, NR 8 or CR 7 R 7 ; W is O, NR 8 or CR 7 R 7 ; and R 7 and R 8 are as defined herein.
  • Q is any one of IIIa-IIIi wherein R 8 is H and R 7 is selected from the group consisting of H, F, Cl, Me, methoxy, hydroxyethoxy, methoxyethoxy, acetoxyethoxy, methylsulfonyl methylsulfonylmethyl, phenyl and morpholin-4-yl.
  • Q is IIId.
  • Q is IIId which is substituted at the 4-position with R 7 .
  • Q is IIId which is substituted at the 5-position with R 7 .
  • X 1 and X 2 are each independently O or S. In a particular embodiment, X 1 and X 2 are both O. In another particular embodiment X 1 and X 2 are both S. In another particular embodiment, X 1 is S while X 2 is O. In another particular embodiment, X 1 is O while X 2 is S.
  • Y is a bond, (CR 7 R 7 ) n , O or S; wherein n is 1 or 2 and R 7 is H, halogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, amino, arylamino, alkylamino, aralkylamino, alkoxy, aryloxy or aralkyloxy.
  • Y is (CHR 7 ) n , O or S; wherein n is 1 or 2 and R 7 is H, halogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, amino, arylamino, alkylamino, aralkylamino, alkoxy, aryloxy or aralkyloxy.
  • Y is CH 2 .
  • n is 1.
  • Y is a bond.
  • n is 1 and Y is CHR 7 wherein R 7 is aralkyloxy, for example benzyloxy.
  • n is 1 and Y is CHR 7 wherein R 7 is F.
  • n is 1 and Y is CHR 7 wherein R 7 is aralkylamino, for example benzylamino.
  • Y is O.
  • Y is S.
  • R 1 is H or R 1 and R 2 together form a 5-8 member ring.
  • R 1 is H.
  • R 1 and R 2 together form a 6-member ring.
  • R 1 and R 2 together form a 7-member ring.
  • R 1 and R 2 together form an 8-member ring.
  • R 1 and R 2 together form a 7-member ring while Y is S.
  • R 1 is H, while Y is CH 2 .
  • R 1 is H, while Y is S.
  • R 1 is H, while Y is O.
  • R 2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, oxo, thione, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, sulfonyl, amino and nitro.
  • R 2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, oxo, mercapto, thione, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, sulfonyl, amino and nitro.
  • R 2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino and nitro.
  • R 2 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl. In a particular embodiment R 2 is alkyl, cycloalkyl or a heterocycle.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of t-butyl, isopropyl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydropyran-4-yl, N-methylsulfonylpiperidin-4-yl, tetrahydrothiopyran-4-yl, tetrahydrothiopyran-4-yl (in which the S is in oxidized form SO or SO 2 ), cyclohexan-4-one, 4-hydroxycyclohexane, 4-hydroxy-4-methylcyclohexane, 1-methyl-tetrahydropyran-4-yl, 2-hydroxyprop-2-yl, but-2-yl, phenyl and 1-hydroxyeth-1-yl.
  • R 2 is t-butyl, isopropyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopentyl, phenyl or tetrahydropyran-4-yl.
  • R 2 is phenyl.
  • R 2 is cyclohexyl.
  • R 2 is tetrahydropyran-4-yl.
  • R 2 is isopropyl (i.e. the valine amino acid side chain).
  • R 2 is t-butyl.
  • R 2 is oriented such that the amino acid, or amino acid analogue, which it comprises is in the L-configuration.
  • R 3 is H or alkyl optionally substituted with halogen or hydroxyl; or R 3 and R 4 together form a 3-6 heterocycle. In an embodiment R 3 is H or alkyl; or R 3 and R 4 together form a 3-6 heterocycle. In an embodiment R 3 is H or methyl, ethyl, propyl or isopropyl. In a particularly particular embodiment R 3 is H or methyl. In a another particular embodiment R 3 is methyl. In another particular embodiment R 3 is methyl. In another particular embodiment, R 3 is ethyl. In a particular embodiment R 3 is fluoromethyl. In a particular embodiment R 3 is hydroxyethyl. In another embodiment R 3 is oriented such that the amino acid, or amino acid analogue, which it comprises is in the L-configuration.
  • R 3 and R 4 together with the atoms from which they depend form a 3-6 heterocycle. In a particular embodiment R 3 and R 4 together form an azetidine ring. In a particular embodiment R 3 and R 4 together form a pyrrolidine.
  • R 3 ′ is H, or R 3 and R 3 ′ together form a 3-6 carbocycle. In an embodiment, R 3 ′ is H. In another embodiment R 3 and R 3 ′ together form a 3-6 carbocycle, for example a cyclopropyl ring. In a particular embodiment R 3 and R 3 ′ are both methyl.
  • R 4 and R 4 ′ are independently H, hydroxyl, amino, alkyl, carbocycle, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy or heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl; wherein each alkyl, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy and heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl is optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino, imino and nitro; or R 4 and R 4 ′ together form a heterocycle.
  • R 4 and R 4 ′ are independently H, hydroxyl, amino, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylalkyl wherein each alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl and heteroarylalkyl is optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino and nitro; or R 4 and R 4 ′ together form a heterocycle.
  • R 4 and R 4 ′ together form a heterocycle, for example an azetidine ring, or a pyrrolidine ring.
  • R 4 and R 4 ′ are both H.
  • R 4 is methyl and R 4 ′ is H.
  • one of R 4 and R 4 ′ is hydroxyl (OH) while the other is H.
  • one of R 4 and R 4 ′ is amino, such as NH 2 , NHMe and NHEt, while the other is H.
  • R 4 ′ is H and R 4 is H, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl.
  • R 4 is a group selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 is H or alkyl. In a particular embodiment, R 5 is H or methyl. In a particular embodiment, R 5 is H. In another particular embodiment, R 5 is methyl.
  • R 6 , and R 6 ′ are each independently H, alkyl, aryl or aralkyl.
  • R 6 is alkyl, for example methyl.
  • R 6 is aryl, for example phenyl.
  • R 6 is aralkyl, for example benzyl.
  • R 6 and R 6 ′ are the same, for example both alkyl, e.g. both methyl.
  • R 6 is methyl and R 6 ′ is H.
  • R 6 and R 6′ are both H.
  • Compounds of the invention contain one or more asymmetric carbon atoms. Accordingly, the compounds may exist as diastereomers, enantiomers or mixtures thereof. The syntheses of the compounds may employ racemates, diastereomers or enantiomers as starting materials or as intermediates. Diastereomeric compounds may be separated by chromatographic or crystallization methods. Similarly, enantiomeric mixtures may be separated using the same techniques or others known in the art. Each of the asymmetric carbon atoms may be in the R or S configuration and both of these configurations are within the scope of the invention. In a particular embodiment, compounds of the invention have the following stereochemical configuration of formula I′
  • Q is a carbocycle or a heterocycle optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle wherein one or more CH 2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O) 2 , —N(R 8 )—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—, —SO 2 —NR 8 —, —NR 8 —SO
  • Q is aryl or heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle wherein one or more CH 2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O) 2 , —N(R 8 )—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—, —SO 2 —NR 8 —, —NR 8 —SO 2 —, —NR 8 —C(O)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—NR 8 —, —NR 8 —C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or
  • Q is aryl or heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, alkoxyalkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino.
  • Q is aryl or heteroaryl optionally substituted with halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, alkoxyalkoxy, cyano.
  • Q is IIIa to IIIs wherein R 7 , R 8 and n are as defined herein.
  • Q is IIIq.
  • Q is IIId.
  • Q is IIIb, IIIc, IIIe, IIIf, IIIj, IIIk, IIIl, IIIn, IIIo, IIIq, IIIr or IIIs.
  • R 1 is H.
  • R 2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino and nitro.
  • R 3 is H or methyl, ethyl, propyl or isopropyl.
  • R 4 is methyl and R 4 ′ is H.
  • R 5 is H.
  • R 6 and R 6 are both H.
  • R 7 is H, halogen, cyano, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl or alkoxyalkyl.
  • X 1 and X 2 are both O.
  • Y is CH 2 .
  • prodrugs of the compounds described above include known amino-protecting and carboxy-protecting groups which are released, for example hydrolyzed, to yield the parent compound under physiologic conditions.
  • a particular class of prodrugs are compounds in which a nitrogen atom in an amino, amidino, aminoalkyleneamino, iminoalkyleneamino or guanidino group is substituted with a hydroxy (OH) group, an alkylcarbonyl (—CO—R) group, an alkoxycarbonyl (—CO—OR), an acyloxyalkyl-alkoxycarbonyl (—CO—O—R—O—CO—R) group where R is a monovalent or divalent group and as defined above or a group having the formula —C(O)—O—CP1P2-haloalkyl, where P1 and P2 are the same or different and are H, lower alkyl, lower alkoxy, cyano, halo lower alkyl or
  • the nitrogen atom is one of the nitrogen atoms of the amidino group of the compounds of the invention.
  • These prodrug compounds are prepared reacting the compounds of the invention described above with an activated acyl compound to bond a nitrogen atom in the compound of the invention to the carbonyl of the activated acyl compound.
  • Suitable activated carbonyl compounds contain a good leaving group bonded to the carbonyl carbon and include acyl halides, acyl amines, acyl pyridinium salts, acyl alkoxides, in particular acyl phenoxides such as p-nitrophenoxy acyl, dinitrophenoxy acyl, fluorophenoxy acyl, and difluorophenoxy acyl.
  • the reactions are generally exothermic and are carried out in inert solvents at reduced temperatures such as ⁇ 78 to about 50 C.
  • the reactions are usually also carried out in the presence of an inorganic base such as potassium carbonate or sodium bicarbonate, or an organic base such as an amine, including pyridine, triethylamine, etc.
  • an inorganic base such as potassium carbonate or sodium bicarbonate
  • an organic base such as an amine, including pyridine, triethylamine, etc.
  • amino acid analogs may be coupled in any order and may be prepared using solid phase support which is routine in the art.
  • Scheme 2 illustrates an alternative amino acid residue analogue coupling route.
  • the intermediate incorporating ring A is prepared from commercially available reagents employing standard organic chemistry techniques.
  • the intermediate may be prepared according to scheme 3.
  • the intermediate may be prepared according to scheme 4.
  • R 4 or R 4 ′ are other than H may be prepared according to standard organic chemistry techniques, for example by reductive amination in which a starting amino acid residue analog e.g. NH 2 —CH(R 3 )—C(O)—OH is reacted with a suitable aldehyde or ketone to give the desired R 4 and R 4 ′ substituents. See scheme 5. The resulting R 4 /R 4 ′ substituted amino acid intermediate can then be conjugated to the next amino acid intermediate or the remainder of the compound using standard peptide coupling procedures.
  • a starting amino acid residue analog e.g. NH 2 —CH(R 3 )—C(O)—OH
  • alanine is reacted with 1-methylindole-2-carboxaldehyde and reduced with sodium cyanoborohydride dissolved in 1% HOAc/DMF to give the N-substituted alanine residue which may be used in preparing compounds of the invention. See scheme 6.
  • the reductive amination procedure to introduce R 4 /R 4 ′ substituents is the final step in the preparation of the compound.
  • R 4 or R 4 ′ substituents other than H they may also be prepared by substitution of a suitable acid intermediate which incorporates a leaving group with a desired amine.
  • a suitable acid intermediate which incorporates a leaving group with a desired amine.
  • Br—CH(R 3 )—C(O)—OH is substituted with an amine R 4 —NH 2 or R 4 —NH—R 4 ′ according to scheme 7.
  • substitution reaction introducing R 4 or R 4 ′ substituents may be performed as a final step in the preparation of the compound as illustrated in scheme 8.
  • 2-bromopropionic acid is reacted with the following amines dissolved in DMF and bubbled for until substitution is complete to form N-substituted alanine residues:
  • X 1 or X 2 is sulfur
  • X 1 or X 2 is sulfur
  • compounds in which X 2 is sulfur can be prepared according to scheme 9 starting from an Fmoc protected amino acid residue analog NH 2 —CH(R 2 )—COOH which is dissolved in THF and cooled to ⁇ 25° C., with addition of DIPEA followed by addition of isobutylchloroformate. After 10 minutes, the diamine, 4-nitrobenzene-1,2-diamine, is added and the reaction mixture is continuously stirred at ⁇ 25° C. for 2 hours, then at room temperature overnight.
  • THF is vacuumed off and the mixture is then subjected to flash chromatography using 50% EtOAc/Hexane to yield the product.
  • the Fmoc-alanine derivative, phosphorus pentasulfide and sodium carbonate are mixed in THF and stirred overnight.
  • the solution is concentrated and direct chromatography using 80% EtOAc/Hexane yields the activated thioalanine.
  • the activated thioalanine and sodium nitrite are then mixed in acetic acid and diluted with H 2 O.
  • the resulting precipitant is filtered and dried to yield the product.
  • the thioalanine is coupled to an A ring substituted proline amino acid residue analog by dissolving both in DMF.
  • the thioamide product may then be deprotected with 20% PIP/DMA for 15 minutes and used to conjugate to the R 4 /R 4 ′—N—C(R 3 )(R 3 ′)—COOH.
  • the Fmoc-protected thioamide is first coupled to the A ring substituted proline amino acid residue analog followed by Fmoc deprotection and subsequent coupling to the R 4 /R 4 ′—R 4 /R 4 ′—N—C(R 3 )(R 3 ′)—COOH amino acid residue analog.
  • the compounds of the invention inhibit the binding of IAP proteins to caspases, in particular X-IAP binding interaction with caspases 3 and 7.
  • the compounds also inhibit the binding of ML-IAP to Smac protein.
  • the compounds of the invention are useful for inducing apoptosis in cells or sensitizing cells to apoptotic signals, in particular cancer cells.
  • Compounds of the invention are useful for inducing apoptosis in cells that overexpress IAP proteins.
  • compounds of the invention are useful for inducing apoptosis in cells in which the mitochondrial apoptotic pathway is disrupted such that release of Smac from ML-IAP proteins is inhibited, for example by up regulation of Bcl-2 or down regulation of Bax/Bak. More broadly, the compounds can be used for the treatment of all cancer types which fail to undergo apoptosis.
  • cancer types include neuroblastoma, intestine carcinoma such as rectum carcinoma, colon carcinoma, familiary adenomatous polyposis carcinoma and hereditary non-polyposis colorectal cancer, esophageal carcinoma, labial carcinoma, larynx carcinoma, hypopharynx carcinoma, tong carcinoma, salivary gland carcinoma, gastric carcinoma, adenocarcinoma, medullary thyroidea carcinoma, papillary thyroidea carcinoma, renal carcinoma, kidney parenchym carcinoma, ovarian carcinoma, cervix carcinoma, uterine corpus carcinoma, endometrium carcinoma, chorion carcinoma, pancreatic carcinoma, prostate carcinoma, testis carcinoma, breast carcinoma, urinary carcinoma, melanoma, brain tumors such as glioblastoma, astrocytoma, meningioma, medulloblastoma and peripheral neuroectodermal tumors, Hodgkin lymphoma, non-Hodgkin lymphoma, Burkitt lymphoma
  • cytostatic chemotherapy compounds include, but are not limited to (i) antimetabolites, such as cytarabine, fludarabine, 5-fluoro-2′-deoxyuiridine, gemcitabine, hydroxyurea or methotrexate; (ii) DNA-fragmenting agents, such as bleomycin, (iii) DNA-crosslinking agents, such as chlorambucil, cisplatin, cyclophosphamide or nitrogen mustard; (iv) intercalating agents such as adriamycin (doxorubicin) or mitoxantrone; (v) protein synthesis inhibitors, such as L-asparaginase, cycloheximide, puromycin or diphtheria toxin; (Vi) topoi
  • antimetabolites such as cytarabine, fludarabine, 5-fluoro-2′-deoxyuiridine, gemcitabine, hydroxyurea or methotrexate
  • DNA-fragmenting agents such as
  • compounds of the present invention are coadministered with a cytostatic compound selected from the group consisting of cisplatin, doxorubicin, taxol, taxotere and mitomycin C.
  • a cytostatic compound selected from the group consisting of cisplatin, doxorubicin, taxol, taxotere and mitomycin C.
  • the cytostatic compound is doxorubicin.
  • Another class of active compounds which can be used in the present invention are those which are able to sensitize for or induce apoptosis by binding to death receptors (“death receptor agonists”).
  • death receptor agonists include death receptor ligands such as tumor necrosis factor a (TNF- ⁇ ), tumor necrosis factor ⁇ (TNF- ⁇ , lymphotoxin- ⁇ ), LT- ⁇ (lymphotoxin- ⁇ ), TRAIL (Apo2L, DR4 ligand), CD95 (Fas, APO-1) ligand, TRAMP (DR3, Apo-3) ligand, DR6 ligand as well as fragments and derivatives of any of said ligands.
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor a
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor ⁇
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor ⁇
  • lymphotoxin- ⁇ lymphotoxin- ⁇
  • LT- ⁇ lymphotoxin- ⁇
  • TRAIL Ap
  • the death receptor ligand is TNF- ⁇ .
  • the death receptor ligand is Apo2L/TRAIL.
  • death receptors agonists comprise agonistic antibodies to death receptors such as anti-CD95 antibody, anti-TRAIL-R1 (DR4) antibody, anti-TRAIL-R2 (DR5) antibody, anti-TRAIL-R3 antibody, anti-TRAIL-R4 antibody, anti-DR6 antibody, anti-TNF-R1 antibody and anti-TRAMP (DR3) antibody as well as fragments and derivatives of any of said antibodies.
  • the compounds of the present invention can be also used in combination with radiation therapy.
  • radiation therapy refers to the use of electromagnetic or particulate radiation in the treatment of neoplasia. Radiation therapy is based on the principle that high-dose radiation delivered to a target area will result in the death of reproducing cells in both tumor and normal tissues.
  • the radiation dosage regimen is generally defined in terms of radiation absorbed dose (rad), time and fractionation, and must be carefully defined by the oncologist.
  • the amount of radiation a patient receives will depend on various consideration but the two most important considerations are the location of the tumor in relation to other critical structures or organs of the body, and the extent to which the tumor has spread.
  • radiotherapeutic agents are provided in, but not limited to, radiation therapy and is known in the art (Hellman, Principles of Radiation Therapy, Cancer, in Principles I and Practice of Oncology, 24875 (Devita et al., 4th ed., vol 1, 1993).
  • Recent advances in radiation therapy include three-dimensional conformal external beam radiation, intensity modulated radiation therapy (IMRT), stereotactic radiosurgery and brachytherapy (interstitial radiation therapy), the latter placing the source of radiation directly into the tumor as implanted “seeds”.
  • IMRT intensity modulated radiation therapy
  • stereotactic radiosurgery stereotactic radiosurgery
  • brachytherapy interstitial radiation therapy
  • Ionizing radiation with beta-emitting radionuclides is considered the most useful for radiotherapeutic applications because of the moderate linear energy transfer (LET) of the ionizing particle (electron) and its intermediate range (typically several millimeters in tissue).
  • LET linear energy transfer
  • Gamma rays deliver dosage at lower levels over much greater distances.
  • Alpha particles represent the other extreme, they deliver very high LET dosage, but have an extremely limited range and must, therefore, be in intimate contact with the cells of the tissue to be treated.
  • alpha emitters are generally heavy metals, which limits the possible chemistry and presents undue hazards from leakage of radionuclide from the area to be treated. Depending on the tumor to be treated all kinds of emitters are conceivable within the scope of the present invention.
  • the present invention encompasses types of non-ionizing radiation like e.g. ultraviolet (UV) radiation, high energy visible light, microwave radiation (hyperthermia therapy), infrared (IR) radiation and lasers.
  • UV radiation is applied.
  • the invention also includes pharmaceutical compositions or medicaments containing the compounds of the invention and a therapeutically inert carrier, diluent or excipient, as well as methods of using the compounds of the invention to prepare such compositions and medicaments.
  • the compounds of formula I used in the methods of the invention are formulated by mixing at ambient temperature at the appropriate pH, and at the desired degree of purity, with physiologically acceptable carriers, i.e., carriers that are non-toxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed into a galenical administration form.
  • physiologically acceptable carriers i.e., carriers that are non-toxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed into a galenical administration form.
  • the pH of the formulation depends mainly on the particular use and the concentration of compound, but may range anywhere from about 3 to about 8.
  • Formulation in an acetate buffer at pH 5 is a suitable embodiment.
  • the inhibitory compound for use herein is sterile. The compound ordinarily will be stored as a solid composition, although lyophilized formulations or a
  • composition of the invention will be formulated, dosed, and administered in a fashion consistent with good medical practice.
  • Factors for consideration in this context include the particular disorder being treated, the particular mammal being treated, the clinical condition of the individual patient, the cause of the disorder, the site of delivery of the agent, the method of administration, the scheduling of administration, and other factors known to medical practitioners.
  • the “effective amount” of the compound to be administered will be governed by such considerations, and is the minimum amount necessary to inhibit IAP interaction with caspases, induce apoptosis or sensitize a malignant cell to an apoptotic signal. Such amount is may be below the amount that is toxic to normal cells, or the mammal as a whole.
  • the initial pharmaceutically effective amount of the compound of the invention administered parenterally per dose will be in the range of about 0.01-100 mg/kg, for example about 0.1 to 20 mg/kg of patient body weight per day, with the typical initial range of compound used being 0.3 to 15 mg/kg/day.
  • Oral unit dosage forms, such as tablets and capsules, may contain from about 25 to about 1000 mg of the compound of the invention.
  • the compound of the invention may be administered by any suitable means, including oral, topical, transdermal, parenteral, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intrapulmonary, and intranasal, and, if desired for local treatment, intralesional administration.
  • Parenteral infusions include intramuscular, intravenous, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, or subcutaneous administration.
  • An example of a suitable oral dosage form is a tablet containing about 25 mg, 50 mg, 100 mg, 250 mg, or 500 mg of the compound of the invention compounded with about 90-30 mg anhydrous lactose, about 5-40 mg sodium croscarmellose, about 5-30 mg polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP) K30, and about 1-10 mg magnesium stearate.
  • PVP polyvinylpyrrolidone
  • the powdered ingredients are first mixed together and then mixed with a solution of the PVP.
  • the resulting composition can be dried, granulated, mixed with the magnesium stearate and compressed to tablet form using conventional equipment.
  • An aerosol formulation can be prepared by dissolving the compound, for example 5-400 mg, of the invention in a suitable buffer solution, e.g. a phosphate buffer, adding a tonicifier, e.g. a salt such sodium chloride, if desired.
  • the solution is typically filtered, e.g. using a 0.2 micron filter, to remove impurities and contaminants.
  • ACN acetonitrile
  • Chg cyclohexylglycine
  • DCM dichloromethane
  • DIPEA diisopropylethylamine
  • DMAP 4-dimethylaminopyridine
  • DME 1,2-dimethoxyethane
  • DMF dimethylformamide
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • EDC 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide
  • EEDQ 2-ethoxy-1-ethoxycarbonyl-1,2-dihydroquinoline
  • LCMS liquid chromatography mass spectrometry
  • HATU O-(7-Azobenzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate
  • HATU O-(7-Azobenzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate
  • HBTU 2-(1H-Benzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-Tetramethyl-uronium Hexafluorophosphate
  • HPLC high performance liquid chromatography
  • NBS N-bromosuccinamide
  • TASF tris(dimethylamino)sulfonium difluorotrimethylsilicate
  • TEA triethylamine
  • TFA trifluoroacetate
  • THF tetrahydrofuran
  • Phenyl magnesium bromide (2.1 mL of 1.0 M solution in THF, 2.1 mmol) was added dropwise to a cold ( ⁇ 78° C.) solution of ester c (360 mg, 1.0 mmol) in THF (5 mL) over 5 min. The cooling bath was removed and the solution allowed to reach room temperature, at which time it was poured into saturated aqueous NH 4 Cl (50 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes (3 ⁇ 10 mL). The combined organic layers were dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO 2 , gradient elution, 30-40% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 404 mg (84%) of thiazole d as a colorless solid.
  • Triethylsilane (850 ⁇ l, 5.3 mmol) and TFA (5 mL) were added sequentially to alcohol d, and the resulting solution was allowed stand at rt for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated, and the residue purified by flash chromatography (SiO 2 , 30% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford a quantitative yield of compound e as a colorless oil.
  • Phenylmagnesium bromide (4.4 mL of 1.0 M solution in THF, 4.4 mmol) was added dropwise to a cold ( ⁇ 78° C.) solution of ester e (600 mg, 2.0 mmol) in THF (10 mL) over 5 min. The cooling bath was removed and the solution allowed to reach rt, at which time it was poured into saturated aqueous NH 4 Cl (50 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes (3 ⁇ 10 mL). The combined organic layers were dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered, and concentrated.
  • Triethylsilane (20 ⁇ l) and TFA (1 mL) were added sequentially to a solution of alcohol f (50 mg, 0.1 mmol) and CH 2 Cl 2 (1 mL). The resulting solution was allowed stand at rt for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated, and the residue partitioned between EtOAc (20 mL) and 1N NaOH (20 mL). The organic phase was washed with 1N NaOH (2 ⁇ 20 mL).
  • the mixture was adsorbed onto Celite, and chromatographed (ISCO, 120 g silica column, 0-20% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 1.15 g (55%) of the nitrile g as a yellow solid.
  • Methylmagnesium chloride (8.5 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 25.5 mmol) was added dropwise to a cold (0° C.) solution of amide z (2.5 g, 8.5 mmol) and THF (80 mL). The resulting solution was stirred at 0° C. for 1 h, then allowed to warm to room temperature. After 2.5 h, it was quenched by slow addition of aqueous AcOH (50%, 10 mL), diluted with water (100 mL), and separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (1 ⁇ 100 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (MgSO 4 ), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 1.9 g (90%) of ketone a′ as a yellow solid.
  • Trimethylsilyl cyanide (4.5 mL, 34.1 mmol) was added slowly into a mixture of 5-methoxy-1-tetralone d′ (5.0 g, 28.4 mmol), catalytic ZnI 2 in toluene (12 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 h. Pyridine (40 mL) and POCl 3 (8.0 mL, 85.2 mmol) were added, and the mixture was heated to reflux for 8 h. The cooled dark solution was poured into ice water (300 mL) and conc.
  • nitrile f′ (2.20 g, 12.0 mmol) afforded 1.64 g (68%) of ketone g′ as a brown oil.
  • Trifluoroacetic acid (3.85 mL, 50 mmol) was added to a stirred solution of fluoro compound l′ (1.23 g, 5.0 mmol) in CH 2 Cl 2 (50 mL) at rt. After stirring for 3 h, the solution was concentrated in vacuo to afford 0.95 g (100%) of fluoro acid m′ as an oil, which was carried on.
  • chloro compound q′ (2.63 g, 14.1 mmol) afforded 2.1 g (74%) of chloro ketone r′ as a yellow liquid.
  • the mixture was diluted with 1 ⁇ 2-saturated ammonium chloride and filtered through a pad of celite.
  • the aqueous mixture was extracted with 70% diethyl ether in hexane (3 ⁇ 20 mL), dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and chromatographed (ISCO, 40 g column and a solvent gradient of 0-11% ethyl acetate in hexane after flushing with hexane for 3 minutes).
  • Terminal alkyne product 27 mg (5%) was isolated along with 200 mg of silyl derivative.
  • the TMS group was removed from this material by treatment with potassium carbonate (200 mg) in methanol (5 mL) for 3 hours at rt.
  • Terminal alkyne m 50 mg, 0.12 mmol was dissolved in THF (0.3 mL) and cooled to ⁇ 78° C.
  • LHMDS (0.15 mL of a 1.0 M solution of in THF, 0.15 mmol) was added dropwise and allowed to stir for 10 minutes.
  • Methyl iodide (0.1 mL, excess) was added, the reaction was stirred for 10 minutes at ⁇ 78° C. and then allowed to gradually warm to rt, over 45 minutes.
  • Typical HATU coupling A mixture of amine a (169 mg, 0.59 mmol), N-Boc-t-butly glycine (150 mg, 0.65 mmol), HATU (450 mg, 1.18 mmol), DIPEA (200 ⁇ l, 1.18 mmol) and DMF (2 mL) was maintained at rt for 2 h. The solution was diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL) and washed with 1 N HCl (3 ⁇ 10 mL), 1 N NaOH (3 ⁇ 5 mL), brine (1 ⁇ 10 mL), dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO— 2 , 10-15-20% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 286 mg (97%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Boc amine b (317 mg, 0.64 mmol) afforded a quantitative yield of amine c as a colorless solid.
  • the solid residue was purified by reverse-phase HPLC (C 18 , MeCN—H 2 O, 0.1% TFA) and the solvents removed by lyophilization to provide 1.2 g (43%) of dipeptide N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-cyclohexylglycine as a white powder.
  • the amine b prepared above was combined with CH 2 Cl 2 (40 mL), saturated aqueous NaHCO 3 (40 mL) and cooled to 0° C. Benzyloxy carbonyl chloride (3.0 mL) was then added dropwise and the mixture stirred vigorously overnight. The phases were separated and the aqueous phase extracted with CH 2 Cl 2 (3 ⁇ 20 mL).
  • a particular procedure for convergent coupling A mixture of amine h (69 mg, 0.26 mmol), dipeptide N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-cyclohexylglycine from example 7 (60 mg, 0.23 mmol), HOAt (Carpino, L. A.; El-Faham, A. Tetrahedron, 1999, 55, 6813) (47 mg, 0.24 mmol), DIC (53 ⁇ l, 0.34 mmol) and CH 2 Cl 2 (2 mL) was maintained at rt overnight.
  • the mixture was adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography (ISCO, 4 g silica column, gradient elution 5-50% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 94 mg of the product i as a colorless solid contaminated with diisopropyl urea.
  • the mixture was carried on directly to the next step.
  • the starting acid a (6.6 g, 30.4 mmol) was treated with thionyl chloride (50 mL), CHCl 3 (50 mL), and 1 drop of DMF at 78° C. for 5 h.
  • the resulting mixture was concentrated in vacuo, dried under high vacuum for overnight.
  • the resulting yellow solid was cooled in an ice-water bath and MeOH (200 mL) was added slowly. This was then refluxed for 1 h. After cooled to RT, the resulting precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with cold MeOH, and dried to afford 5.0 g (71%) of ester b as a yellow solid.
  • the aqueous phase was extracted with CH 2 Cl 2 (2 ⁇ 50 mL). The combined CH 2 Cl 2 were washed with sat. sodium thiosulfate (100 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (1-8% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 3.1 (66%) of chloro ester b as a white solid.
  • benzisoxazole amide a (740 mg, 3.3 mmol) afforded 390 mg (66%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as an off white solid.
  • difluoro ester a (9.2 g, 46.0 mmol) afforded 5.57 g (53%) of difluoro oxime b as a white solid.
  • difluoro ester a (10.8 g, 54 mmol) afforded 4.9 g (40%) of difluoro oxime b as a white solid.
  • benzisoxazole amide a (1.95 g, 8.7 mmol) afforded 448 mg (30%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as a brown oil.
  • Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Farooq et al. (WO 9614305).
  • benzisoxazole amide a (1.70 g, 7.6 mmol) afforded 192 mg (14%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as a white crystalline solid.
  • Lithium hydroxide (1.45 g, 34.5 mmol) was added to a solution of dihydroquinoline ester a (1.50 g, 6.91 mmol) in THF (40 mL), followed by water (10 mL). The mixture was stirred at RT for 16 h. It was concentrated in vacuo, diluted with EtOAc (100 mL) and 0.5 N HCl (100 mL). A white solid precipitated and was collected by filtration, washed with water. The EtOAc was separated, dried (MgSO 4 ), concentrated in vacuo to afford a white solid product. A combined yields of 1.41 g (100%) of dihydroquinoline acid b as a white solid, which was used with out further purification.
  • N,N-Diisopropylethylamine (1.37 g, 10.7 mmol) was added to a suspension of dihydroquinoline acid a (2.42 g, 11.9 mmol), amine (1.40 g, 14.3 mmol), and EDC (2.28 g, 11.9 mmol) in MeCN (80 mL), stirred at RT for 2 h.
  • dihydroquinoline amide a (2.17 g, 8.82 mmol)
  • CH 3 MgCl (8.82 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 26.5 mmol) afforded 766 mg (43%) of dihydroquinoline ketone b as a yellow solid.
  • Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Fujita et al. ( Chem . & Pharm. Bull 2001, 49(7), 900-904 and Chem . & Pharm. Bull. 2001, 49(4), 407-412).
  • dihydroisoquinoline acid a (1.25 g, 6.2 mmol) prepared according to the procedures described by Deady et al. ( J. Heterocyclic Chem. 2001, 38, 1185) afforded 754 mg (50%) of dihydroisoquinoline amide b as a yellow gum.
  • dihydroisoquinoline amide a (0.754 g, 3.06 mmol) afforded 510 mg (85%) of dihydroisoquinoline ketone b as a yellow solid.
  • Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Alvarez et al. ( Science of Synthesis 2005, 15, 839-906), Kimura et al. ( Chem . & Pharm. Bull 1983, 31(4), 1277-82), Tomisawa et al. ( Chem . & Pharm. Bull 1975, 23(3), 592-6) and Dyke et al. ( Tetrahedron 1973, 29(23), 3881-8).
  • bromo acid a (3.0 g, 11.9 mmol) afforded 2.67 g (77%) of bromo amide b as a white solid.
  • bromo amide a (1.0 g, 3.4 mmol) afforded 800 mg (94%) of bromo ketone b as an off white solid.
  • Trifluoromethane sulfonic anhydride (6.82 g, 24.2 mmol) was added drop wise onto to a mixture of ethyl-4-hydroxyquinoline carboxylate a (5.0 g, 23.0 mmol) and pyridine (1.95 mL, 24.2 mmol) in CH 2 Cl 2 (100 mL) at ice water bath temperature under N 2 . The mixture was stirred at RT overnight. It was diluted with CH 2 Cl 2 (100 mL), washed with 0.5 N NaOH (100 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 80 g column (2-15% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 7.4 g (93%) of triflate b as a white solid.
  • ketone ester a (1.50 g, 6.17 mmol), KOH (640 mg, 11.35 mmol) in EtOH (30 mL) was stirred at RT overnight.
  • the reaction mixture was diluted with water (150 mL), extracted with EtOAc (100 mL).
  • the aqueous layer was then acidified with 1 N HCl, extracted with EtOAc (2 ⁇ 100 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), concentrated in vacuo afforded 1.53 g (100%) of ketone acid b as a yellow solid.
  • Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Priestly et al. ( Bioorg . & Med. Chem. 1996, 4(7), 1135-1147).
  • amide a (3.29 g, 11.26 mmol) afforded 3.29 g (118%) of ketone b as a yellow solid.
  • Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Sato et al. (JP 2002371078), Wong et al (WO 9846572), Leardini et al. ( J. Chem. Soc., Chem. Communications 1984, 20, 1320-1), Kaneko et al. ( Chem . & Pharm. Bull. 1982, 30(1), 74-85), Schwenk et al. ( J. Org. Chem. 1946, 11, 798-802) and Shivers et al ( J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1947, 69, 119-23).
  • amide a (1.88 g, 8.1 mmol) afforded 993 mg (66%) of ketone b as a light yellow solid.
  • Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Wetzel et al. ( J. Med. Chem. 1973, 16(5), 528-32), Jones et al. ( J. Chem. Soc . [Section C]: Organic 1967, 19, 1808-13) and Ochia et al. ( Chem . & Pharm. Bull. 1963, 11, 137-8).
  • Boc-ester a (900 mg, 2.0 mmol) was dissolved in THF (20 mL) and MeOH (1 mL) at ice water bath temperature. NaBH 4 (300 mg, 8.0 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred for 1 h then another 1 h at RT. Reaction was quenched with the addition of few drops of water, then diluted with more water (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2 ⁇ 100 mL), dried (MgSO 4 ), and concentrated in vacuo to afford 739 mg (90%) of alcohol b as a yellow foamy solid.
  • Boc-amine a (175 mg, 0.26 mmol) was treated with (1:1) TFA/CH 2 Cl 2 (8 mL), catalytic toluene at RT for 1 h. Solvent was removed in vacuo. The residue was purified by reverse-phase HPLC (C 18 , MeCN—H 2 O, 0.1% TFA) and lyophilized to afford 98 mg (49%, in 2 steps) of desired product b as a hygroscopic white solid.
  • Boc-ester a 200 mg, 0.30 mmol
  • LiOH 200 mg, 0.30 mmol
  • water 25 ⁇ L
  • MeOH 500 ⁇ L
  • ester a (780 mg), CH 2 Cl 2 (5 mL), and TFA (2 mL) was maintained at rt overnight. The solvents were removed under reduced pressure to afford quantitative yield acid b as a colorless oil which was used without further purification.
  • pivaloyl chloride (3.2 mL, 26 mmol) was added to a ⁇ 10° C. solution of acid a (3.72 g, 23.5 mmol), TEA (4.3 mL, 31 mmol) and THF (50 mL). The resulting white slurry was allowed to warm to ⁇ 5° C. over 20 min with vigorous stirring. The mixture was then cooled to ⁇ 78° C.
  • TrsylN 3 (6.9 g, 22.4 mmol) and THF (40 mL) was added via cannula over 5 min.
  • Acetic acid (5.3 mL, 90 mmol) was added and the mixture was immediately brought to 30° C. and held there for 1 h.
  • the reaction was quenched with brine (200 mL) and CH 2 Cl 2 (200 mL). The phases were separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with CH 2 Cl 2 (2 ⁇ 50 mL).
  • Diisopropyl zinc (3 ml of 10M solution in toluene, 2.5 mmol) was added to a mixture of chloride a (500 mg, 1.8 mmol), NiCl 2 DPPP (115 mg, 0.18 mmol), and THF (3 mL) The dark solution was then heated at 100° C. in a ⁇ W reactor for 15 min. The reaction was then quenched into saturated NH 4 Cl (50 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3 ⁇ 20 mL).
  • Methyl magnesium chloride (12.3 mL of 3.0M in THF, 37 mmol) was added to 0° C. solution of amide a (2.84 g, 10.51 mmol) and THF (20 mL). The solution was allowed to come to rt, then maintained at that temp. for 4 h. The reaction was quenched into cold saturated NH 4 Cl (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (3 ⁇ 50 mL).
  • Methyl magnesium chloride (7.3 mL of 3.0M in THF, 22 mmol) was added to 0° C. solution of amide a (1.77 g, 6.2 mmol) and THF (15 mL). The solution was allowed to come to rt, then maintained at that temp. for 4 h. The reaction was quenched into cold saturated NH 4 Cl (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (3 ⁇ 50 mL).
  • Trifluoromethane sulfonic anhydride (5.0 g, 17.7 mmol) was added drop wise to a mixture of 2-methyl-4-hydroxyquinoline a (2.56 g, 16.1 mmol) and pyridine (1.54 mL, 17.7 mmol) in CH 2 Cl 2 (25 mL) at ice water bath temperature under N 2 . The mixture was allowed to warm to 10° C.
  • Tetrahydropyranylglycine was purchased from NovaBiochem, or synthesized according to the literature: Ghosh, A. K.; Thompson, W. J.; Holloway, M. K.; McKee, S. P.; Duong, T. T.; Lee, H. Y.; Munson, P. M.; Smith, A. M.; Wai, J. M; Darke, P. L.; Switzerlanday, J. A.; Emini, E. A.; Schleife, W. A.; Huff, J. R.; Anderson, P. S. J. Med. Chem., 1993, 36, 2300-2310.
  • Piperidinylglycine was synthesized according to the procedures described by Shieh et al. ( Tetrahedron: Asymmetry, 2001, 12, 2421-2425.
  • L-alanine methyl ester hydrochloride a (5 g, 35.8 mmol) and cyclopropanecarboxaldehyde b (2.67 ml, 35.8 mmol) were suspended in 50 ml THF w/1% AcOH. Addition of 5 ml of CH 3 OH made the cloudy solution turned to clear. NaCNBH 4 (2.25 g, 35.8 mmol) was added and the reaction mixture stirred overnight. The reaction was quenched by addition of 1N aq. NaOH, extracted by EtOAc twice, organic layers were dried over Na 2 SO 4 and concentrated to dryness.
  • the crude material was purified by chromatography using 30% EtOAc/hexane (stained by ninhydrin) to obtain the compound c (1 g, 18%).
  • the compound c (1 g, 6.37 mmol) and di-t-bocdicarbonate (2.1 g, 9.55 mmol) were diluted in THF (20 ml) and H 2 O (20 ml), NaHCO 3 (1.3 g, 15.9 mmol) was added.
  • the reaction mixture stirred overnight for completion.
  • THF was removed under reduced pressure, and the aqueous layer was extracted by EtOAc 3 times. Combined organic layers were washed by 1N NaOH, sat, NH 4 Cl followed by brine, the concentrated to dryness.
  • Phosphonate b (7.2 g, 21 mmol) was dissolved in THF (25 mL) at room temperature, and TMG (3.6 mL, 29 mmol, 1.3 equiv) was added dropwise. The mixture was stirred for 15 min at room temp.
  • Commercially available ketone a (6.7 g, 43 mmol) was dissolved in THF (25 mL) and added dropwise to the mixture of phosphonate and base. The reaction was stirred for 24 h at room temperature and quenched by adding approx 200 mL of 1 N HCl. Organic products were quickly extracted into 80% ethyl acetate-hexanes (400 mL total).
  • Ketal a (1.56 g, 4.73 mmol) was dissolved in 6 mL of THF. To this solution was added deionized water (15 mL), glacial acetic acid (6 mL), and dichloroacetic acid (1 mL). The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. Aqueous 1 N sodium hydroxide (approx. 100 mL) was added, and crude product was extracted into dichloromethane (approx. 200 mL).
  • Ester a (184 mg, 0.55 mmol) was dissolved in 2 mL of THF. Deionized water was added (1 mL), followed by lithium hydroxide monohydrate (42 mg, 1.0 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, then acidified using aqueous 1 N HCl and extracted into dichloromethane. Drying (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtration and evaporation of the solvent yielded 175 mg (quantitative yield) of the carboxylic acid b.
  • the BOC-protected amine obtained from this coupling reaction was dissolved in dichloromethane (2 mL), deionized water (0.5 mL) and trifluoroacetic acid (1 mL) and allowed to stir for 3 h at room temperature. Organic solvents were removed under reduced pressure, the aqueous layer was made basic using a small amount of 1 N NaOH, and product was extracted into dichloromethane. Removal of organic solvent yielded 110 mg (0.25 mmol, 45% amine #) of the free amine #.
  • Standard EDC coupling procedure was performed using amine b (110 mg, 0.25 mmol) L-BOC-N-methylalanine a (72 mg, 0.35 mmol) and EDC (67 mg, 0.35 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 5-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min followed by 55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 4 min.
  • BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • Final product c 54 mg, 66%) was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C 18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min.
  • the product BOC-protected amine b was dissolved in 5 mL of THF. The following solvents were then added sequentially: deionized water (15 mL), glacial acetic acid (30 mL), and dichloroacetic acid (3 mL). The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature, and the reaction was quenched by slowly adding solid sodium carbonate with vigorous stirring until the release of gas was no longer visible. Crude product was extracted into 10% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane.
  • the product was adsorbed onto Celite by evaporation of the solvents, and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-36% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 20 min followed by flushing with 36% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 5 min to afford 2.86 g (10.0 mmol, 91%) of ketone b.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (46 mg, 0.15 mmol), carboxylic acid a (42 mg, 0.15 mmol syn-diastereomer) and EDC (33 mg, 0.17 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash stacker 2 ⁇ 4 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min, followed by 28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • the TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into dichloromethane.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (110 mg, 0.38 mmol), carboxylic acid a, (105 mg, 0.38 mmol) and EDC (86 mg, 0.45 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash stacker 2 ⁇ 4 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min, followed by 28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • the TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into dichloromethane.
  • Ketone a (1.45 g, 5.3 mmol), was dissolved in dry diethyl ether (20 mL) and cooled to ⁇ 78° C.
  • Methyllithium (1.6 M in Et 2 O, 9.5 mL, 15 mmol) was added dropwise to the reaction mixture and stirred vigorously at the reduced temperature for 1 h. The reaction was quenched by pouring the cold mixture into saturated aqueous ammonium chloride and extracting the organics into dichloromethane.
  • the organic layer was dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered, adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column, 0-50% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 25 min, followed by flushing 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min, and 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min.
  • This purification afforded 344 mg (1.1 mmol, 42%) of the syn-diastereomer c and 299 mg (0.99 mmol, 37%) of the anti-diastereomer b.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (62 mg, 0.21 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (32 mg, 0.11 mmol) and EDC (21 mg, 0.11 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 22 min, followed by 67% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • the TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into ethyl acetate with 10% dichloromethane.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (82 mg, 0.27 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (95 mg, 0.33 mmol) and EDC (65 mg, 0.34 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 22 min, followed by 67% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • the TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into ethyl acetate with 10% dichloromethane.
  • alkene a (774 mg 2.19 mmol), dry methanol (40 mL), and [(S,S)-Me-BPE-Rh(COD)] + OTf ⁇ (500 mg, 0.8 mmol) were mixed in a Parr shaker flask purged with nitrogen. Parr shaker was evacuated and subsequently charged to 60 psi of hydrogen gas and shaken vigorously overnight. Methanol was removed under reduced pressure, and crude product was filtered through a small plug of silica gel using ethyl acetate. Evaporation of the solvent yielded 730 mg (2.0 mmol, 94%) of product b with >98% yield.
  • Ester a (508 mg, 1.56 mmol) was dissolved in 8 mL of THF. Deionized water (4 mL) was added, followed by LiOH.H 2 O (120 mg, 2.8 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, acidified using aqueous 1 N HCl and extracted into ethyl acetate. Drying (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtration and evaporation of the solvent yielded 372 mg (1.21 mmol, 78% yield) of the carboxylic acid b, clean enough to use in the next step without purification.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (100 mg, 0.2 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (58 mg, 0.29 mmol) and EDC (56 mg, 0.29 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-65% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C 18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 132 mg.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (130 mg, 0.3 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (60 mg, 0.28 mmol) and EDC (60 mg, 0.3 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-65% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C 18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 78 mg.
  • Impurities were extracted into 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes, the aqueous layer was then acidified by adding solid citric acid until the pH reached 2-3. The product was extracted into 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes. This organic layer was dried (Na 2 SO 4 ) and filtered. Removal of the solvents under reduced pressure afforded a quantitative yield of the product b.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (70 mg, 0.16 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (49 mg, 0.24 mmol) and EDC (46 mg, 0.24 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water.
  • Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C 18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 82 mg.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (64 mg, 0.14 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (41 mg, 0.2 mmol) and EDC (38 mg, 0.2 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 10 min, followed by a steady flow of 55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min.
  • Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water.
  • Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C 18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 70.2 mg.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine hydrochloride b (250 mg, 0.67 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (187 mg, 0.81 mmol), DIPEA (0.35 mL, 2.0 mmol) and EDC (157 mg, 0.81 mmol). Reaction was stirred at room temperature for 48 h. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-25% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 10 min, followed by a steady flow of 26% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using HCl in dioxane (4.0 M, 3.0 mL).
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine hydrochloride # (250 mg, 0.67 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (187 mg, 0.81 mmol), DIPEA (0.350 mL, 2.0 mmol) and EDC (157 mg, 0.81 mmol). Reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3 h. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-25% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 10 min, followed by a steady flow of 26% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using HCl in dioxane (4.0 M, 3.0 mL).
  • EDC coupling was performed using amine hydrochloride b (230 mg, 0.61 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (165 mg, 0.75 mmol), DIPEA (0.350 mL, 2.0 mmol) and EDC (157 mg, 0.81 mmol). Reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3 h, LC/MS indicated only half complete. More carboxylic acid (160 mg) and EDC (150 mg) was added to the reaction, and the mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature.
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-55% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 17 min, followed by a steady flow of 56% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 5 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Coupling of the product primary amine c (199 mg, 0.5 mmol) to L-BOC-N-methylalanine (140 mg, 0.7 mmol) was performed with EDC (135 mg, 0.7 mmol) and dichloromethane (3 mL).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min followed by 40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C 18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of final product was 178 mg.
  • Methyl ketone a (480 mg, 3.0 mmol), synthesized according to the general procedure of Miki [Miki, Y.; Nakamura, N.; Hachiken, H.; Takemura, S. J. Heterocyclic Chem., 1989, 26, 1739-1745], was suspended in 33% HBr in acetic acid (6 mL). Elemental bromine was added in six portions (6 ⁇ 0.025 mL, 0.15 mL total, 3.0 mmol) with vigorous stirring at room temperature. The reaction appeared to have a light color after 10 min of stirring, when diethyl ether was added (10 mL). Stirring at room temperature was continued for 30 min.
  • the mixture was filtered through a frit, and the solids left behind were rinsed with 20 mL of ether, transferred to a vial, and dried under high vacuum.
  • the solid afforded (840 mg) was a mixture of desired product b and the HBr salt of the starting material, used without further purification in the thiazole-forming step.
  • the mixture was then diluted with deionized water, poured into ethyl acetate in a separatory funnel, and made acidic by the addition of 6 N HCl. After extracting into ethyl acetate, the organic layer was washed with deionized water, followed by brine. The organic layer was dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford clean FMOC-protected amino acid c (1.05 g, 3.19 mmol, 32%) to be used without further purification.
  • reaction mixture was then allowed to cool to room temperature, and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2 ⁇ 30 mL). The organic layer was dried (Na 2 SO 4 ), filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 910 mg (2.7 mmol) of oxazolidinone b.
  • the oxazolidinone (337 mg, 0.99 mmol) was dissolved in dichloromethane (20 mL). To this solution was added anhydrous aluminum trichloride (260 mg, 2.0 mmol), followed by triethylsilane (0.32 mL, 2.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 5 h at room temperature and then quenched with 20 mL of 1 N aqueous HCl.
  • the product carboxylic acid was extracted into 25% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane and washed with 1 N aqueous HCl (20 mL) followed by brine. The organic layer was dried (Na 2 SO 4 ) and filtered. Celite was added, and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The crude product adsorbed onto Celite was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column, 1-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 25 min, to afford 272 mg (0.79 mmol, 25% yield from FMOC-primary amine) of the FMOC protected N-methyl amino acid c.
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine # (140 mg, 0.4 mmol), the crude carboxylic acid a, (176 mg, 0.4 mmol) and EDC (80 mg, 0.4 mmol).
  • BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column with a solvent gradient of 1-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min. The desired BOC-protected product was split into two portions for removing the FMOC group. The first portion (50 mg, 0.065 mmol) was dissolved in dichloromethane (1.0 mL), treated with piperidine (0.10 mL, 1.0 mmol), and allowed to stir at room temperature for 2 h.
  • MLXBIR3SG a chimeric BIR domain referred to as MLXBIR3SG in which 11 of 110 residues correspond to those found in XIAP-BIR3, while the remainder correspond to ML-IAP-BIR.
  • the chimeric protein MLXBIR3SG was shown to bind and inhibit caspase-9 significantly better than either of the native BIR domains, but bound Smac-based peptides and mature Smac with affinities similar to those of native ML-IAP-BIR.
  • the improved caspase-9 inhibition of the chimeric BIR domain MLXBIR3SG has been correlated with increased inhibition of doxorubicin-induced apoptosis when transfected into MCF7 cells.
  • this cocktail can be made using europium-labeled anti-His (Perkin Elmer) and streptavidin-allophycocyanin (Perkin Elmer) at concentrations of 6.5 nM and 25 nM, respectively).
  • the reagent cocktail was incubated at room temperature for 30 minutes. After incubation, the cocktail was added to 1:3 serial dilutions of an antagonist compound (starting concentration of 50 ⁇ M) in 384-well black FIA plates (Greiner Bio-One, Inc.).
  • Samples for fluorescence polarization affinity measurements were prepared by addition of 1:2 serial dilutions starting at a final concentration of 5 ⁇ M of MLXBIR3SG in polarization buffer (50 mM Tris [pH 7.2], 120 mM NaCl, 1% bovine globulins 5 mM DTT and 0.05% octylglucoside) to 5-carboxyflourescein-conjugated AVPdi-Phe-NH 2 (AVP-diPhe-FAM) at 5 nM final concentration.
  • polarization buffer 50 mM Tris [pH 7.2], 120 mM NaCl, 1% bovine globulins 5 mM DTT and 0.05% octylglucoside

Abstract

The invention provides novel inhibitors of IAP that are useful as therapeutic agents for treating malignancies where the compounds have the general formula I:
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00001
wherein A, Q, X1, X2, Y, R1, R2, R3, R4, R4′, R5, R6 and R6′ are as described herein.

Description

    RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation application of U.S. application Ser. No. 11/312,063, filed Dec. 19, 2005, which claims priority under 35 U.S.C. § 119(e)(1) to U.S. provisional application 60/638,202 filed on Dec. 20, 2004 which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • FIELD OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention relates to organic compounds useful for therapy and/or prophylaxis in a mammal, and in particular to inhibitors of IAP proteins useful for treating cancers.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • Apoptosis or programmed cell death is a genetically and biochemically regulated mechanism that plays an important role in development and homeostasis in invertebrates as well as vertebrates. Aberrancies in apoptosis that lead to premature cell death have been linked to a variety of developmental disorders. Deficiencies in apoptosis that result in the lack of cell death have been linked to cancer and chronic viral infections (Thompson et al., (1995) Science 267, 1456-1462).
  • One of the key effector molecules in apoptosis are the caspases (cysteine containing aspartate specific proteases). Caspases are strong proteases, cleaving after aspartic acid residues and once activated, digest vital cell proteins from within the cell. Since caspases are such strong proteases, tight control of this family of proteins is necessary to prevent premature cell death. In general, caspases are synthesized as largely inactive zymogens that require proteolytic processing in order to be active. This proteolytic processing is only one of the ways in which caspases are regulated. The second mechanism is through a family of proteins that bind and inhibit caspases.
  • A family of molecules that inhibit caspases are the Inhibitors of Apoptosis (IAP) (Deveraux et al., J Clin Immunol (1999), 19:388-398). IAPs were originally discovered in baculovirus by their functional ability to substitute for P35 protein, an anti-apoptotic gene (Crook et al. (1993) J Virology 67, 2168-2174). IAPs have been described in organisms ranging from Drosophila to human. Regardless of their origin, structurally, IAPs comprise one to three Baculovirus IAP repeat (BIR) domains, and most of them also possess a carboxyl-terminal RING finger motif. The BIR domain itself is a zinc binding domain of about 70 residues comprising 4 alpha-helices and 3 beta strands, with cysteine and histidine residues that coordinate the zinc ion (Hinds et al., (1999) Nat. Struct. Biol. 6, 648-651). It is the BIR domain that is believed to cause the anti-apoptotic effect by inhibiting the caspases and thus inhibiting apoptosis. As an example, human X-chromosome linked IAP (XIAP) inhibits caspase 3, caspase 7 and the Apaf-1-cytochrome C mediated activation of caspase 9 (Deveraux et al., (1998) EMBO J. 17, 2215-2223). Caspases 3 and 7 are inhibited by the BIR2 domain of XIAP, while the BIR3 domain of XIAP is responsible for the inhibition of caspase 9 activity. XIAP is expressed ubiquitously in most adult and fetal tissues (Liston et al, Nature, 1996, 379(6563):349), and is overexpressed in a number of tumor cell lines of the NCI 60 cell line panel (Fong et al, Genomics, 2000, 70:113; Tamm et al, Clin. Cancer Res. 2000, 6(5):1796). Overexpression of XIAP in tumor cells has been demonstrated to confer protection against a variety of pro-apoptotic stimuli and promotes resistance to chemotherapy (LaCasse et al, Oncogene, 1998, 17(25):3247). Consistent with this, a strong correlation between XIAP protein levels and survival has been demonstrated for patients with acute myelogenous leukemia (Tamm et al, supra). Down-regulation of XIAP expression by antisense oligonucleotides has been shown to sensitize tumor cells to death induced by a wide range of pro-apoptotic agents, both in vitro and in vivo (Sasaki et al, Cancer Res., 2000, 60(20):5659; Lin et al, Biochem J., 2001, 353:299; Hu et al, Clin. Cancer Res., 2003, 9(7):2826). Smac/DIABLO-derived peptides have also been demonstrated to sensitize a number of different tumor cell lines to apoptosis induced by a variety of pro-apoptotic drugs (Arnt et al, J. Biol. Chem., 2002, 277(46):44236; Fulda et al, Nature Med., 2002, 8(8):808; Guo et al, Blood, 2002, 99(9):3419; Vucic et al, J. Biol. Chem., 2002, 277(14):12275; Yang et al, Cancer Res., 2003, 63(4):831).
  • Melanoma IAP (ML-IAP) is an IAP not detectable in most normal adult tissues but is strongly upregulated in melanoma (Vucic et al., (2000) Current Bio 10:1359-1366). Determination of protein structure demonstrated significant homology of the ML-IAP BIR and RING finger domains to corresponding domains present in human XIAP, C-IAP1 and C-IAP2. The BIR domain of ML-IAP appears to have the most similarities to the BIR2 and BIR3 of XIAP, C-IAP1 and C-IAP2, and appears to be responsible for the inhibition of apoptosis, as determined by deletional analysis. Furthermore, Vucic et al., demonstrated that ML-IAP could inhibit chemotherapeutic agent induced apoptosis. Agents such as adriamycin and 4-tertiary butylphenol (4-TBP) were tested in a cell culture system of melanomas overexpressing ML-IAP and the chemotherapeutic agents were significantly less effective in killing the cells when compared to a normal melanocyte control. The mechanism by which ML-IAP produces an anti-apoptotic activity is in part through inhibition of caspase 3 and 9. ML-IAP did not effectively inhibit caspases 1, 2, 6, or 8.
  • Since apoptosis is a strictly controlled pathway with multiple interacting factors, the discovery that IAPs themselves are regulated was not unusual. In the fruit fly Drosophila, the Reaper (rpr), Head Involution Defective (hid) and GRIM proteins physically interact with and inhibit the anti-apoptotic activity of the Drosophila family of IAPs. In the mammal, the proteins SMAC/DIABLO act to block the IAPs and allow apoptosis to proceed. It was shown that during normal apoptosis, SMAC is processed into an active form and is released from the mitochondria into the cytoplasm where it physically binds to IAPs and prevents the IAP from binding to a caspase. This inhibition of the IAP allows the caspase to remain active and thus proceed with apoptosis. Interestingly, sequence homology between the IAP inhibitors shows that there is a four amino acid motif in the N-terminus of the processed, active proteins. This tetrapeptide appears to bind into a hydrophobic pocket in the BIR domain and disrupts the BIR domain binding to caspases (Chai et al., (2000) Nature 406:855-862, Liu et al., (2000) Nature 408:1004-1008, Wu et al., (2000) Nature 408 1008-1012).
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • In one aspect of the present invention there is provided novel inhibitors of IAP proteins having the general formula I:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00002
  • wherein
    • A is a 5-member aromatic heterocycle incorporating 1 to 4 heteroatoms N, O or S and is optionally substituted with one or more R7 and R8 groups;
    • Q is H, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and an alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle;
    • X1 and X2 are each independently O or S;
    • Y is a bond, (CR7R7)n, O or S; wherein n is 1 or 2 and R7 is H, halogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, amino, arylamino, alkylamino, aralkylamino, alkoxy, aryloxy or aralkyloxy;
    • R1 is H or R1 and R2 together form a 5-8 member heterocycle;
    • R2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, oxo, thione, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, sulfonyl, amino and nitro;
    • R3 is H or alkyl optionally substituted with halogen or hydroxyl; or R3 and R4 together form a 3-6 heterocycle;
    • R3′ is H, or R3 and R3′ together form a 3-6 carbocycle;
    • R4 and R4′ are independently H, hydroxyl, amino, alkyl, carbocycle, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy or heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl; wherein each alkyl, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy and heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl is optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino, imino and nitro; or R4 and R4′ together form a heterocycle;
    • R5 is H or alkyl;
    • R6, and R6′ are each independently H, alkyl, aryl or aralkyl;
    • R7 is H, cyano, hydroxyl, mercapto, halogen, nitro, carboxyl, amidino, guanidino, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle or —U—V; wherein U is —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)— and V is alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; and wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and an alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle;
    • R8 is H, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8), or —C(O)—; and said alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo (═O), carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle;
      and salts and solvates thereof.
  • In another aspect of the invention, there are provided compositions comprising compounds of formula I and a carrier, diluent or excipient.
  • In another aspect of the invention, there is provided a method of inducing apoptosis in a cell comprising introducing into said cell a compound of formula I.
  • In another aspect of the invention, there is provided a method of sensitizing a cell to an apoptotic signal comprising introducing into said cell a compound of formula I.
  • In another aspect of the invention, there is provided a method for inhibiting the binding of an IAP protein to a caspase protein comprising contacting said IAP protein with a compound of formula I.
  • In another aspect of the invention, there is provided a method for treating a disease or condition associated with the overexpression of an IAP protein in a mammal, comprising administering to said mammal an effective amount of a compound of formula I.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS
  • “Acyl” means a carbonyl containing substituent represented by the formula —C(O)—R in which R is H, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle, carbocycle-substituted alkyl or heterocycle-substituted alkyl wherein the alkyl, alkoxy, carbocycle and heterocycle are as defined herein. Acyl groups include alkanoyl (e.g. acetyl), aroyl (e.g. benzoyl), and heteroaroyl.
  • “Alkyl” means a branched or unbranched, saturated or unsaturated (i.e. alkenyl, alkynyl) aliphatic hydrocarbon group, having up to 12 carbon atoms unless otherwise specified. When used as part of another term, for example “alkylamino”, the alkyl portion may be a saturated hydrocarbon chain, however also includes unsaturated hydrocarbon carbon chains such as “alkenylamino” and “alkynylamino. Examples of particular alkyl groups are methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, iso-butyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, n-pentyl, 2-methylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, n-hexyl, 2-methylpentyl, 2,2-dimethylbutyl, n-heptyl, 3-heptyl, 2-methylhexyl, and the like. The terms “lower alkyl” “C1-C4 alkyl” and “alkyl of 1 to 4 carbon atoms” are synonymous and used interchangeably to mean methyl, ethyl, 1-propyl, isopropyl, cyclopropyl, 1-butyl, sec-butyl or t-butyl. Unless specified, substituted, alkyl groups may contain one, for example two, three or four substituents which may be the same or different. Examples of substituents are, unless otherwise defined, halogen, amino, hydroxyl, protected hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxy, alkoxy, nitro, cyano, amidino, guanidino, urea, sulfonyl, sulfinyl, aminosulfonyl, alkylsulfonylamino, arylsulfonylamino, aminocarbonyl, acylamino, alkoxy, acyl, acyloxy, a carbocycle, a heterocycle. Examples of the above substituted alkyl groups include, but are not limited to; cyanomethyl, nitromethyl, hydroxymethyl, trityloxymethyl, propionyloxymethyl, aminomethyl, carboxymethyl, carboxyethyl, carboxypropyl, alkyloxycarbonylmethyl, allyloxycarbonylaminomethyl, carbamoyloxymethyl, methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, t-butoxymethyl, acetoxymethyl, chloromethyl, bromomethyl, iodomethyl, trifluoromethyl, 6-hydroxyhexyl, 2,4-dichloro(n-butyl), 2-amino(iso-propyl), 2-carbamoyloxyethyl and the like. The alkyl group may also be substituted with a carbocycle group. Examples include cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, and cyclohexylmethyl groups, as well as the corresponding-ethyl, -propyl, -butyl, -pentyl, -hexyl groups, etc. Substituted alkyls include substituted methyls e.g. a methyl group substituted by the same substituents as the “substituted Cn-Cm alkyl” group. Examples of the substituted methyl group include groups such as hydroxymethyl, protected hydroxymethyl (e.g. tetrahydropyranyloxymethyl), acetoxymethyl, carbamoyloxymethyl, trifluoromethyl, chloromethyl, carboxymethyl, bromomethyl and iodomethyl.
  • “Amidine” means the group —C(NH)—NHR wherein R is H or alkyl or aralkyl. A particular amidine is the group —NH—C(NH)—NH2.
  • “Amino” means primary (i.e. —NH2), secondary (i.e. —NRH) and tertiary (i.e. —NRR) amines. Particular secondary and tertiary amines are alkylamine, dialkylamine, arylamine, diarylamine, aralkylamine and diaralkylamine wherein the alkyl is as herein defined and optionally substituted. Particular secondary and tertiary amines are methylamine, ethylamine, propylamine, isopropylamine, phenylamine, benzylamine dimethylamine, diethylamine, dipropylamine and disopropylamine.
  • “Amino-protecting group” as used herein refers to a derivative of the groups commonly employed to block or protect an amino group while reactions are carried out on other functional groups on the compound. Examples of such protecting groups include carbamates, amides, alkyl and aryl groups, imines, as well as many N-heteroatom derivatives which can be removed to regenerate the desired amine group. Particular amino protecting groups are Boc, Fmoc and Cbz. Further examples of these groups are found in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, 2nd ed., John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1991, chapter 7; E. Haslam, “Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry”, J. G. W. McOmie, Ed., Plenum Press, New York, N.Y., 1973, Chapter 5, and T. W. Greene, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, John Wiley and Sons, New York, N.Y., 1981. The term “protected amino” refers to an amino group substituted with one of the above amino-protecting groups.
  • “Aryl” when used alone or as part of another term means a carbocyclic aromatic group whether or not fused having the number of carbon atoms designated or if no number is designated, up to 14 carbon atoms. Particular aryl groups are phenyl, naphthyl, biphenyl, phenanthrenyl, naphthacenyl, and the like (see e.g. Lang's Handbook of Chemistry (Dean, J. A., ed) 13th ed. Table 7-2 [1985]). A particular aryl is phenyl. Substituted phenyl or substituted aryl means a phenyl group or aryl group substituted with one, two, three, four or five, for example 1-2, 1-3 or 1-4 substituents chosen, unless otherwise specified, from halogen (F, Cl, Br, I), hydroxy, protected hydroxy, cyano, nitro, alkyl (for example C1-C6 alkyl), alkoxy (for example C1-C6 alkoxy), benzyloxy, carboxy, protected carboxy, carboxymethyl, protected carboxymethyl, hydroxymethyl, protected hydroxymethyl, aminomethyl, protected aminomethyl, trifluoromethyl, alkylsulfonylamino, alkylsulfonylaminoalkyl, arylsulfonylamino, arylsulonylaminoalkyl, heterocyclylsulfonylamino, heterocyclylsulfonylaminoalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, or other groups specified. One or more methyne (CH) and/or methylene (CH2) groups in these substituents may in turn be substituted with a similar group as those denoted above. Examples of the term “substituted phenyl” includes but is not limited to a mono- or di(halo)phenyl group such as 2-chlorophenyl, 2-bromophenyl, 4-chlorophenyl, 2,6-dichlorophenyl, 2,5-dichlorophenyl, 3,4-dichlorophenyl, 3-chlorophenyl, 3-bromophenyl, 4-bromophenyl, 3,4-dibromophenyl, 3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl, 2-fluorophenyl and the like; a mono- or di(hydroxy)phenyl group such as 4-hydroxyphenyl, 3-hydroxyphenyl, 2,4-dihydroxyphenyl, the protected-hydroxy derivatives thereof and the like; a nitrophenyl group such as 3- or 4-nitrophenyl; a cyanophenyl group, for example, 4-cyanophenyl; a mono- or di(lower alkyl)phenyl group such as 4-methylphenyl, 2,4-dimethylphenyl, 2-methylphenyl, 4-(iso-propyl)phenyl, 4-ethylphenyl, 3-(n-propyl)phenyl and the like; a mono or di(alkoxy)phenyl group, for example, 3,4-dimethoxyphenyl, 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxyphenyl, 3-methoxy-4-(1-chloromethyl)benzyloxy-phenyl, 3-ethoxyphenyl, 4-(isopropoxy)phenyl, 4-(t-butoxy)phenyl, 3-ethoxy-4-methoxyphenyl and the like; 3- or 4-trifluoromethylphenyl; a mono- or dicarboxyphenyl or (protected carboxy)phenyl group such 4-carboxyphenyl; a mono- or di(hydroxymethyl)phenyl or (protected hydroxymethyl)phenyl such as 3-(protected hydroxymethyl)phenyl or 3,4-di(hydroxymethyl)phenyl; a mono- or di(aminomethyl)phenyl or (protected aminomethyl)phenyl such as 2-(aminomethyl)phenyl or 2,4-(protected aminomethyl)phenyl; or a mono- or di(N-(methylsulfonylamino))phenyl such as 3-(N-methylsulfonylamino))phenyl. Also, the term “substituted phenyl” represents disubstituted phenyl groups where the substituents are different, for example, 3-methyl-4-hydroxyphenyl, 3-chloro-4-hydroxyphenyl, 2-methoxy-4-bromophenyl, 4-ethyl-2-hydroxyphenyl, 3-hydroxy-4-nitrophenyl, 2-hydroxy-4-chlorophenyl, and the like, as well as trisubstituted phenyl groups where the substituents are different, for example 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxy-6-methyl sulfonylamino, 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxy-6-phenyl sulfonylamino, and tetrasubstituted phenyl groups where the substituents are different such as 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxy-5-methyl-6-phenyl sulfonylamino. Particular substituted phenyl groups include the 2-chlorophenyl, 2-aminophenyl, 2-bromophenyl, 3-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxy-phenyl, 4-benzyloxyphenyl, 4-methoxyphenyl, 3-ethoxy-4-benzyloxyphenyl, 3,4-diethoxyphenyl, 3-methoxy-4-benzyloxyphenyl, 3-methoxy-4-(1-chloromethyl)benzyloxy-phenyl, 3-methoxy-4-(1-chloromethyl)benzyloxy-6-methyl sulfonyl aminophenyl groups. Fused aryl rings may also be substituted with any, for example 1, 2 or 3, of the substituents specified herein in the same manner as substituted alkyl groups.
  • “Carbocyclyl”, “carbocyclylic”, “carbocycle” and “carbocyclo” alone and when used as a moiety in a complex group such as a carbocycloalkyl group, refers to a mono-, bi-, or tricyclic aliphatic ring having 3 to 14 carbon atoms, for example 3 to 7 carbon atoms, which may be saturated or unsaturated, aromatic or non-aromatic. Particular saturated carbocyclic groups are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl groups. A particular saturated carbocycle is cyclopropyl. Another particular saturated carbocycle is cyclohexyl. Particular unsaturated carbocycles are aromatic e.g. aryl groups as previously defined, for example phenyl. The terms “substituted carbocyclyl”, “carbocycle” and “carbocyclo” mean these groups substituted by the same substituents as the “substituted alkyl” group.
  • “Carboxy-protecting group” as used herein refers to one of the ester derivatives of the carboxylic acid group commonly employed to block or protect the carboxylic acid group while reactions are carried out on other functional groups on the compound. Examples of such carboxylic acid protecting groups include 4-nitrobenzyl, 4-methoxybenzyl, 3,4-dimethoxybenzyl, 2,4-dimethoxybenzyl, 2,4,6-trimethoxybenzyl, 2,4,6-trimethylbenzyl, pentamethylbenzyl, 3,4-methylenedioxybenzyl, benzhydryl, 4,4′-dimethoxybenzhydryl, 2,2′,4,4′-tetramethoxybenzhydryl, alkyl such as t-butyl or t-amyl, trityl, 4-methoxytrityl, 4,4′-dimethoxytrityl, 4,4′,4″-trimethoxytrityl, 2-phenylprop-2-yl, trimethylsilyl, t-butyldimethylsilyl, phenacyl, 2,2,2-trichloroethyl, beta-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl, beta-(di(n-butyl)methylsilyl)ethyl, p-toluenesulfonylethyl, 4-nitrobenzylsulfonylethyl, allyl, cinnamyl, 1-(trimethylsilylmethyl)prop-1-en-3-yl, and like moieties. The species of carboxy-protecting group employed is not critical so long as the derivatized carboxylic acid is stable to the condition of subsequent reaction(s) on other positions of the molecule and can be removed at the appropriate point without disrupting the remainder of the molecule. In particular, it is important not to subject a carboxy-protected molecule to strong nucleophilic bases, such as lithium hydroxide or NaOH, or reductive conditions employing highly activated metal hydrides such as LiAlH4. (Such harsh removal conditions are also to be avoided when removing amino-protecting groups and hydroxy-protecting groups, discussed below.) Particular carboxylic acid protecting groups are the alkyl (e.g. methyl, ethyl, t-butyl), allyl, benzyl and p-nitrobenzyl groups. Similar carboxy-protecting groups used in the cephalosporin, penicillin and peptide arts can also be used to protect a carboxy group substituents. Further examples of these groups are found in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, 2nd ed., John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1991, chapter 5; E. Haslam, “Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry”, J. G. W. McOmie, Ed., Plenum Press, New York, N.Y., 1973, Chapter 5, and T. W. Greene, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, John Wiley and Sons, New York, N.Y., 1981, Chapter 5. The term “protected carboxy” refers to a carboxy group substituted with one of the above carboxy-protecting groups.
  • “Guanidine” means the group —NH—C(NH)—NHR wherein R is H or alkyl or aralkyl. A particular guanidine is the group —NH—C(NH)—NH2.
  • “Hydroxy-protecting group” as used herein refers to a derivative of the hydroxy group commonly employed to block or protect the hydroxy group while reactions are carried out on other functional groups on the compound. Examples of such protecting groups include tetrahydropyranyloxy, benzoyl, acetoxy, carbamoyloxy, benzyl, and silylethers (e.g. TBS, TBDPS) groups. Further examples of these groups are found in T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, 2nd ed., John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1991, chapters 2-3; E. Haslam, “Protective Groups in Organic Chemistry”, J. G. W. McOmie, Ed., Plenum Press, New York, N.Y., 1973, Chapter 5, and T. W. Greene, “Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis”, John Wiley and Sons, New York, N.Y., 1981. The term “protected hydroxy” refers to a hydroxy group substituted with one of the above hydroxy-protecting groups.
  • “Heterocyclic group”, “heterocyclic”, “heterocycle”, “heterocyclyl”, or “heterocyclo” alone and when used as a moiety in a complex group such as a heterocycloalkyl group, are used interchangeably and refer to any mono-, bi-, or tricyclic, saturated or unsaturated, aromatic (heteroaryl) or non-aromatic ring having the number of atoms designated, generally from 5 to about 14 ring atoms, where the ring atoms are carbon and at least one heteroatom (nitrogen, sulfur or oxygen), for example 1 to 4 heteroatoms. Typically, a 5-membered ring has 0 to 2 double bonds and 6- or 7-membered ring has 0 to 3 double bonds and the nitrogen or sulfur heteroatoms may optionally be oxidized (e.g. SO, SO2), and any nitrogen heteroatom may optionally be quaternized. Particular non-aromatic heterocycles are morpholinyl (morpholino), pyrrolidinyl, oxiranyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 2,3-dihydrofuranyl, 2H-pyranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, thiiranyl, thietanyl, tetrahydrothietanyl, aziridinyl, azetidinyl, 1-methyl-2-pyrrolyl, piperazinyl and piperidinyl. A “heterocycloalkyl” group is a heterocycle group as defined above covalently bonded to an alkyl group as defined above. Particular 5-membered heterocycles containing a sulfur or oxygen atom and one to three nitrogen atoms are thiazolyl, in particular thiazol-2-yl and thiazol-2-yl N-oxide, thiadiazolyl, in particular 1,3,4-thiadiazol-5-yl and 1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, oxazolyl, for example oxazol-2-yl, and oxadiazolyl, such as 1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, and 1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl. Particular 5-membered ring heterocycles containing 2 to 4 nitrogen atoms include imidazolyl, such as imidazol-2-yl; triazolyl, such as 1,3,4-triazol-5-yl; 1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 1,2,4-triazol-5-yl, and tetrazolyl, such as 1H-tetrazol-5-yl. Particular benzo-fused 5-membered heterocycles are benzoxazol-2-yl, benzthiazol-2-yl and benzimidazol-2-yl. Particular 6-membered heterocycles contain one to three nitrogen atoms and optionally a sulfur or oxygen atom, for example pyridyl, such as pyrid-2-yl, pyrid-3-yl, and pyrid-4-yl; pyrimidyl, such as pyrimid-2-yl and pyrimid-4-yl; triazinyl, such as 1,3,4-triazin-2-yl and 1,3,5-triazin-4-yl; pyridazinyl, in particular pyridazin-3-yl, and pyrazinyl. The pyridine N-oxides and pyridazine N-oxides and the pyridyl, pyrimid-2-yl, pyrimid-4-yl, pyridazinyl and the 1,3,4-triazin-2-yl groups, are a particular group. Substituents for “optionally substituted heterocycles”, and further examples of the 5- and 6-membered ring systems discussed above can be found in W. Druckheimer et al, U.S. Pat. No. 4,278,793. In a particular embodiment, such optionally substituted heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino.
  • “Heteroaryl” alone and when used as a moiety in a complex group such as a heteroaralkyl group, refers to any mono-, bi-, or tricyclic aromatic ring system having the number of atoms designated where at least one ring is a 5-, 6- or 7-membered ring containing from one to four heteroatoms selected from the group nitrogen, oxygen, and sulfur, and in a particular embodiment at least one heteroatom is nitrogen (Lang's Handbook of Chemistry, supra). Included in the definition are any bicyclic groups where any of the above heteroaryl rings are fused to a benzene ring. Particular heteroaryls incorporate a nitrogen or oxygen heteroatom. The following ring systems are examples of the heteroaryl (whether substituted or unsubstituted) groups denoted by the term “heteroaryl”: thienyl, furyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, thiazolyl, isothiazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, triazolyl, thiadiazolyl, oxadiazolyl, tetrazolyl, thiatriazolyl, oxatriazolyl, pyridyl, pyrimidyl, pyrazinyl, pyridazinyl, thiazinyl, oxazinyl, triazinyl, thiadiazinyl, oxadiazinyl, dithiazinyl, dioxazinyl, oxathiazinyl, tetrazinyl, thiatriazinyl, oxatriazinyl, dithiadiazinyl, imidazolinyl, dihydropyrimidyl, tetrahydropyrimidyl, tetrazolo[1,5-b]pyridazinyl and purinyl, as well as benzo-fused derivatives, for example benzoxazolyl, benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothiadiazolyl, benzotriazolyl, benzoimidazolyl and indolyl. A particular “heteroaryl” is: 1,3-thiazol-2-yl, 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl, 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl sodium salt, 1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 3-methyl-1,2,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-hydroxy-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-carboxy-4-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl sodium salt, 2-carboxy-4-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 1,3-oxazol-2-yl, 1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 2-(hydroxymethyl)-1,3,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 1,2,4-oxadiazol-5-yl, 1,3,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 2-thiol-1,3,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 2-(methylthio)-1,3,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 2-amino-1,3,4-thiadiazol-5-yl, 1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-methyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(1-(dimethylamino)eth-2-yl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(carboxymethyl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(carboxymethyl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl sodium salt, 1-(methylsulfonic acid)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(methylsulfonic acid)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl sodium salt, 2-methyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 1-methyl-1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 4-methyl-1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, pyrid-2-yl N-oxide, 6-methoxy-2-(n-oxide)-pyridaz-3-yl, 6-hydroxypyridaz-3-yl, 1-methylpyrid-2-yl, 1-methylpyrid-4-yl, 2-hydroxypyrimid-4-yl, 1,4,5,6-tetrahydro-5,6-dioxo-4-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl, 1,4,5,6-tetrahydro-4-(formylmethyl)-5,6-dioxo-as-triazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-hydroxy-astriazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-hydroxy-as-triazin-3-yl sodium salt, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-hydroxy-2-methyl-astriazin-3-yl sodium salt, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-hydroxy-2-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-methoxy-2-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-as-triazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-2-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-2,6-dimethyl-as-triazin-3-yl, tetrazolo[1,5-b]pyridazin-6-yl and 8-aminotetrazolo[1,5-b]-pyridazin-6-yl. An alternative group of “heteroaryl” includes; 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl, 4-(carboxymethyl)-5-methyl-1,3-thiazol-2-yl sodium salt, 1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 2-methyl-1,3,4-triazol-5-yl, 1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-methyl-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(1-(dimethylamino)eth-2-yl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(carboxymethyl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(carboxymethyl)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl sodium salt, 1-(methylsulfonic acid)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl, 1-(methylsulfonic acid)-1H-tetrazol-5-yl sodium salt, 1,2,3-triazol-5-yl, 1,4,5,6-tetrahydro-5,6-dioxo-4-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl, 1,4,5,6-tetrahydro-4-(2-formylmethyl)-5,6-dioxo-as-triazin-3-yl, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-hydroxy-2-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl sodium salt, 2,5-dihydro-5-oxo-6-hydroxy-2-methyl-as-triazin-3-yl, tetrazolo[1,5-b]pyridazin-6-yl, and 8-aminotetrazolo[1,5-b]pyridazin-6-yl. Heteroaryl groups are optionally substituted as described for heterocycles.
  • “Inhibitor” means a compound which reduces or prevents the binding of IAP proteins to caspase proteins or which reduces or prevents the inhibition of apoptosis by an IAP protein. Alternatively, “inhibitor” means a compound which prevents the binding interaction of X-IAP with caspases or the binding interaction of ML-IAP with SMAC.
  • “Optionally substituted” unless otherwise specified means that a group may be substituted by one or more (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3 or 4) of the substituents listed for that group in which said substituents may be the same or different. In an embodiment an optionally substituted group has 1 substituent. In another embodiment an optionally substituted group has 2 substituents. In another embodiment an optionally substituted group has 3 substituents.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable salts” include both acid and base addition salts. “Pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salt” refers to those salts which retain the biological effectiveness and properties of the free bases and which are not biologically or otherwise undesirable, formed with inorganic acids such as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, nitric acid, carbonic acid, phosphoric acid and the like, and organic acids may be selected from aliphatic, cycloaliphatic, aromatic, araliphatic, heterocyclic, carboxylic, and sulfonic classes of organic acids such as formic acid, acetic acid, propionic acid, glycolic acid, gluconic acid, lactic acid, pyruvic acid, oxalic acid, malic acid, maleic acid, maloneic acid, succinic acid, fumaric acid, tartaric acid, citric acid, aspartic acid, ascorbic acid, glutamic acid, anthranilic acid, benzoic acid, cinnamic acid, mandelic acid, embonic acid, phenylacetic acid, methanesulfonic acid, ethanesulfonic acid, p-toluenesulfonic acid, salicyclic acid and the like.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable base addition salts” include those derived from inorganic bases such as sodium, potassium, lithium, ammonium, calcium, magnesium, iron, zinc, copper, manganese, aluminum salts and the like. Particularly base addition salts are the ammonium, potassium, sodium, calcium and magnesium salts. Salts derived from pharmaceutically acceptable organic nontoxic bases includes salts of primary, secondary, and tertiary amines, substituted amines including naturally occurring substituted amines, cyclic amines and basic ion exchange resins, such as isopropylamine, trimethylamine, diethylamine, triethylamine, tripropylamine, ethanolamine, 2-diethylaminoethanol, trimethamine, dicyclohexylamine, lysine, arginine, histidine, caffeine, procaine, hydrabamine, choline, betaine, ethylenediamine, glucosamine, methylglucamine, theobromine, purines, piperizine, piperidine, N-ethylpiperidine, polyamine resins and the like. Particularly organic non-toxic bases are isopropylamine, diethylamine, ethanolamine, trimethamine, dicyclohexylamine, choline, and caffeine.
  • “Sulfonyl” means a —SO2—R group wherein R is alkyl, carbocycle, heterocycle, carbocycloalkyl or heterocycloalkyl. Particular sulfonyl groups are alkylsulfonyl (i.e. —SO2-alkyl), for example methylsulfonyl; arylsulfonyl, for example phenylsulfonyl; aralkylsulfonyl, for example benzylsulfonyl.
  • The phrase “and salts and solvates thereof” as used herein means that compounds of the inventions may exist in one or a mixture of salts and solvate forms. For example a compound of the invention may be substantially pure in one particular salt or solvate form or else may be mixtures of two or more salt or solvate forms.
  • The present invention provides novel compounds having the general formula I:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00003
  • wherein A, Q, X1, X2, Y, R1, R2, R3, R4, R4′, R5, R6 and R6′ are as described herein.
  • Ring A is a 5-member aromatic heterocycle incorporating 1 to 4 heteroatoms N, O or S which is substituted with group Q and is optionally further substituted with one or more R7 (for substitutions at a ring carbon atom) and one or more R8 (for substitutions at a ring nitrogen).
  • R7 in each occurrence is independently H, cyano, hydroxyl, mercapto, halogen, nitro, carboxyl, amidino, guanidino, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle or —U—V; wherein U is —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)— and V is alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; and wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and an alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle. Substituents of the “optionally substituted carbocycle” and “optionally substituted heterocycle” are as defined herein. In a particular embodiment such carbocycle and heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino. In an embodiment R7 is H, halogen, cyano, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl or alkoxyalkyl.
  • R8 is H, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8), or —C(O)—; and said alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo (═O), carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle. Substituents of the “optionally substituted carbocycle” and “optionally substituted heterocycle” are as defined herein. In a particular embodiment such carbocycle and heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino. In a particular embodiment R8 is H, alkyl, or acyl. In an embodiment R8 is methyl. In another embodiment R8 is acetyl. In a particular embodiment R8 is H. In an embodiment R7 is H, halogen, amino, hydroxyl, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl or aralkyl. In a particular embodiment R7 is halogen, for example Cl or F. In a particular embodiment R7 is H. It is understood that substitutions defined for R7 and R8 as well as all other variable groups herein are subject to permissible valency.
  • In a particular embodiment ring A has the general formula II:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00004
  • wherein Z1 is NR8, O or S; and Z2, Z3 and Z4 are each independently N or CR7. Group Q is attached to ring A of formula II and II′ at the ring member between Z2 and Z3. In a particular embodiment Z1 is S. In a particular embodiment Z1 is O. In another particular embodiment Z1 is NR8 wherein R8 is as defined herein. In a particular embodiment Z1 is NR8 wherein R8 is H. In another particular embodiment Z1 is NR8 wherein R8 is Me. In another embodiment Z1 is O or S while Z2 is N and Z3 is N or CR7. In a particular embodiment Z1 is S while Z2 is N and Z3 is CR7. In a particular embodiment Z1 is S while Z2 is N and Z3 is CH.
  • In a particular embodiment, ring A is an aromatic heterocyle selected from the group consisting of IIa-IIcc:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00005
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00006
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00007
  • wherein R7 and R8 are as defined herein. Q is not part of ring A and is shown for positional purposes. In a particular embodiment, ring A is any one of the groups IIa-IIz wherein R8 is H and R7 is H, Cl, or hydroxypropynyl. In another particular embodiment, ring A is any one of the groups IIa-IIz wherein R7 and R8 are both H. In another embodiment, ring A is the IIg. In another embodiment, ring A is IIg and R7 is H.
  • Q is H, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R9)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and wherein any of the foregoing alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle. Substituents of the “optionally substituted carbocycle” and “optionally substituted heterocycle” are as defined herein. In a particular embodiment such carbocycle and heterocycle groups are substituted with hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino and guanidino. In a particular embodiment Q is a carbocycle or heterocycle optionally substituted with halogen, amino, oxo, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and wherein said alkyl, carbocycle or heterocycle is optionally substituted with halogen, amino, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkoxy, alkoxyalkoxy, hydroxyalkoxy, alkylthio, acyloxy, acyloxyalkoxy, alkylsulfonyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, alkylsulfinyl, and alkylsulfinylalkyl.
  • In a particular embodiment, Q is a carbocycle or heterocycle selected from the group consisting of IIIa-IIIs:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00008
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00009
  • wherein n is 1-4, for example 1-3, for example 1-2, for example 1; T is O, S, NR8 or CR7R7; W is O, NR8 or CR7R7; and R7 and R8 are as defined herein. In a particular embodiment Q is any one of IIIa-IIIi wherein R8 is H and R7 is selected from the group consisting of H, F, Cl, Me, methoxy, hydroxyethoxy, methoxyethoxy, acetoxyethoxy, methylsulfonyl methylsulfonylmethyl, phenyl and morpholin-4-yl. In another particular embodiment Q is IIId. In a particular embodiment Q is IIId which is substituted at the 4-position with R7. In another particular embodiment Q is IIId which is substituted at the 5-position with R7.
  • X1 and X2 are each independently O or S. In a particular embodiment, X1 and X2 are both O. In another particular embodiment X1 and X2 are both S. In another particular embodiment, X1 is S while X2 is O. In another particular embodiment, X1 is O while X2 is S.
  • Y is a bond, (CR7R7)n, O or S; wherein n is 1 or 2 and R7 is H, halogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, amino, arylamino, alkylamino, aralkylamino, alkoxy, aryloxy or aralkyloxy. In a particular embodiment, Y is (CHR7)n, O or S; wherein n is 1 or 2 and R7 is H, halogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, amino, arylamino, alkylamino, aralkylamino, alkoxy, aryloxy or aralkyloxy. In a particular embodiment, Y is CH2. In a particular embodiment n is 1. In a particular embodiment Y is a bond. In a particular embodiment n is 1 and Y is CHR7 wherein R7 is aralkyloxy, for example benzyloxy. In a particular embodiment n is 1 and Y is CHR7 wherein R7 is F. In a particular embodiment n is 1 and Y is CHR7 wherein R7 is aralkylamino, for example benzylamino. In another particular embodiment Y is O. In another particular embodiment Y is S.
  • R1 is H or R1 and R2 together form a 5-8 member ring. In a particular embodiment, R1 is H. In a particular embodiment, R1 and R2 together form a 6-member ring. In a particular embodiment, R1 and R2 together form a 7-member ring. In another particular embodiment, R1 and R2 together form an 8-member ring. In another particular embodiment, R1 and R2 together form a 7-member ring while Y is S. In another particular embodiment, R1 is H, while Y is CH2. In another particular embodiment, R1 is H, while Y is S. In another particular embodiment, R1 is H, while Y is O.
  • R2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, oxo, thione, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, sulfonyl, amino and nitro. In a particular embodiment R2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, oxo, mercapto, thione, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, sulfonyl, amino and nitro. In an embodiment R2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino and nitro. In a particular embodiment R2 is alkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, aryl, aralkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl. In a particular embodiment R2 is alkyl, cycloalkyl or a heterocycle. In a particular embodiment R2 is selected from the group consisting of t-butyl, isopropyl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydropyran-4-yl, N-methylsulfonylpiperidin-4-yl, tetrahydrothiopyran-4-yl, tetrahydrothiopyran-4-yl (in which the S is in oxidized form SO or SO2), cyclohexan-4-one, 4-hydroxycyclohexane, 4-hydroxy-4-methylcyclohexane, 1-methyl-tetrahydropyran-4-yl, 2-hydroxyprop-2-yl, but-2-yl, phenyl and 1-hydroxyeth-1-yl. In an embodiment of the invention R2 is t-butyl, isopropyl, cyclohexyl, cyclopentyl, phenyl or tetrahydropyran-4-yl. In a particular embodiment, R2 is phenyl. In a particular embodiment, R2 is cyclohexyl. In another embodiment R2 is tetrahydropyran-4-yl. In another particular embodiment, R2 is isopropyl (i.e. the valine amino acid side chain). In another particular embodiment, R2 is t-butyl. In a particular embodiment R2 is oriented such that the amino acid, or amino acid analogue, which it comprises is in the L-configuration.
  • R3 is H or alkyl optionally substituted with halogen or hydroxyl; or R3 and R4 together form a 3-6 heterocycle. In an embodiment R3 is H or alkyl; or R3 and R4 together form a 3-6 heterocycle. In an embodiment R3 is H or methyl, ethyl, propyl or isopropyl. In a particularly particular embodiment R3 is H or methyl. In a another particular embodiment R3 is methyl. In another particular embodiment, R3 is ethyl. In a particular embodiment R3 is fluoromethyl. In a particular embodiment R3 is hydroxyethyl. In another embodiment R3 is oriented such that the amino acid, or amino acid analogue, which it comprises is in the L-configuration. In a particular embodiment R3 and R4 together with the atoms from which they depend form a 3-6 heterocycle. In a particular embodiment R3 and R4 together form an azetidine ring. In a particular embodiment R3 and R4 together form a pyrrolidine.
  • R3′ is H, or R3 and R3′ together form a 3-6 carbocycle. In an embodiment, R3′ is H. In another embodiment R3 and R3′ together form a 3-6 carbocycle, for example a cyclopropyl ring. In a particular embodiment R3 and R3′ are both methyl.
  • R4 and R4′ are independently H, hydroxyl, amino, alkyl, carbocycle, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy or heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl; wherein each alkyl, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy and heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl is optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino, imino and nitro; or R4 and R4′ together form a heterocycle. In an embodiment R4 and R4′ are independently H, hydroxyl, amino, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl, or heteroarylalkyl wherein each alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl and heteroarylalkyl is optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino and nitro; or R4 and R4′ together form a heterocycle. In a particular embodiment R4 and R4′ together form a heterocycle, for example an azetidine ring, or a pyrrolidine ring. In a particular embodiment R4 and R4′ are both H. In another particular embodiment R4 is methyl and R4′ is H. In a particular embodiment one of R4 and R4′ is hydroxyl (OH) while the other is H. In another embodiment, one of R4 and R4′ is amino, such as NH2, NHMe and NHEt, while the other is H. In a particular embodiment, R4′ is H and R4 is H, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkylalkyl, heteroaryl or heteroarylalkyl. In a particular embodiment R4 is a group selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00010
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00011
  • R5 is H or alkyl. In a particular embodiment, R5 is H or methyl. In a particular embodiment, R5 is H. In another particular embodiment, R5 is methyl.
  • R6, and R6′ are each independently H, alkyl, aryl or aralkyl. In a particular embodiment, R6 is alkyl, for example methyl. In another particular embodiment R6 is aryl, for example phenyl. In another particular embodiment R6 is aralkyl, for example benzyl. In a particular embodiment R6 and R6′ are the same, for example both alkyl, e.g. both methyl. In another particular embodiment R6 is methyl and R6′ is H. In another embodiment R6 and R6′ are both H.
  • Compounds of the invention contain one or more asymmetric carbon atoms. Accordingly, the compounds may exist as diastereomers, enantiomers or mixtures thereof. The syntheses of the compounds may employ racemates, diastereomers or enantiomers as starting materials or as intermediates. Diastereomeric compounds may be separated by chromatographic or crystallization methods. Similarly, enantiomeric mixtures may be separated using the same techniques or others known in the art. Each of the asymmetric carbon atoms may be in the R or S configuration and both of these configurations are within the scope of the invention. In a particular embodiment, compounds of the invention have the following stereochemical configuration of formula I′
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00012
  • wherein ring A, Q, X1, X2, Y, R1, R2, R3, R4, R4′, R5, R6 and R6′ are as described herein.
  • In an embodiment, compounds of the invention have the general formula IV
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00013
  • wherein Q, X1, X2, Y, R1, R2, R3, R4, R4′, R5, R6, R6 and R7 are as described herein. In a particular embodiment Q is a carbocycle or a heterocycle optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—. In a particular embodiment, Q is aryl or heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—. In a particular embodiment Q is aryl or heteroaryl optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, alkoxyalkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino. In a particular embodiment Q is aryl or heteroaryl optionally substituted with halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, alkoxyalkoxy, cyano. In an embodiment Q is IIIa to IIIs wherein R7, R8 and n are as defined herein. In a particular embodiment Q is IIIq. In a particular embodiment Q is IIId. In a particular embodiment Q is IIIb, IIIc, IIIe, IIIf, IIIj, IIIk, IIIl, IIIn, IIIo, IIIq, IIIr or IIIs.
  • In an embodiment when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, R1 is H. In an embodiment when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, R2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino and nitro. In an embodiment when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, R3 is H or methyl, ethyl, propyl or isopropyl. In an embodiment when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, R4 is methyl and R4′ is H. In an embodiment when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, R5 is H. In an embodiment when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, R6 and R6 are both H. In an embodiment, when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV R7 is H, halogen, cyano, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl or alkoxyalkyl. In an embodiment, when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, X1 and X2 are both O. In an embodiment, when compounds of the invention have the general formula IV, Y is CH2.
  • The invention also encompasses prodrugs of the compounds described above. Suitable prodrugs where applicable include known amino-protecting and carboxy-protecting groups which are released, for example hydrolyzed, to yield the parent compound under physiologic conditions. A particular class of prodrugs are compounds in which a nitrogen atom in an amino, amidino, aminoalkyleneamino, iminoalkyleneamino or guanidino group is substituted with a hydroxy (OH) group, an alkylcarbonyl (—CO—R) group, an alkoxycarbonyl (—CO—OR), an acyloxyalkyl-alkoxycarbonyl (—CO—O—R—O—CO—R) group where R is a monovalent or divalent group and as defined above or a group having the formula —C(O)—O—CP1P2-haloalkyl, where P1 and P2 are the same or different and are H, lower alkyl, lower alkoxy, cyano, halo lower alkyl or aryl. In a particular embodiment, the nitrogen atom is one of the nitrogen atoms of the amidino group of the compounds of the invention. These prodrug compounds are prepared reacting the compounds of the invention described above with an activated acyl compound to bond a nitrogen atom in the compound of the invention to the carbonyl of the activated acyl compound. Suitable activated carbonyl compounds contain a good leaving group bonded to the carbonyl carbon and include acyl halides, acyl amines, acyl pyridinium salts, acyl alkoxides, in particular acyl phenoxides such as p-nitrophenoxy acyl, dinitrophenoxy acyl, fluorophenoxy acyl, and difluorophenoxy acyl. The reactions are generally exothermic and are carried out in inert solvents at reduced temperatures such as −78 to about 50 C. The reactions are usually also carried out in the presence of an inorganic base such as potassium carbonate or sodium bicarbonate, or an organic base such as an amine, including pyridine, triethylamine, etc. One manner of preparing prodrugs is described in U.S. Ser. No. 08/843,369 filed Apr. 15, 1997 (corresponding to PCT publication WO9846576) the contents of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • Particular compounds of formula I include the following:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00014
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00015
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00016
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00017
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00018
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00019
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00020
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00021
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00022
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00023
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00024
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00025
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00026
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00027
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00028
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00029
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00030
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00031
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00032
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00033
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00034
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00035
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00036
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00037
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00038
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00039
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00040
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00041
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00042
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00043
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00044
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00045
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00046
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00047
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00048
    Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00049
  • Synthesis
  • Compounds of the invention are prepared using standard organic synthetic techniques from commercially available starting materials and reagents. It will be appreciated that synthetic procedures employed in the preparation of compounds of the invention will depend on the particular substituents present in a compound and that various protection and deprotection steps that are standard in organic synthesis may be required but may not be illustrated in the following general schemes. In a particular general synthetic scheme compounds of the invention may be prepared using typical peptide chemistry techniques by coupling amino acid residue analogues employing typical amide coupling procedures. In scheme 1, amine-protected amino acid residue analogues are coupled and deprotected sequentially to give the final compounds.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00050
  • It will be appreciated that the amino acid analogs may be coupled in any order and may be prepared using solid phase support which is routine in the art. For example, Scheme 2 illustrates an alternative amino acid residue analogue coupling route.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00051
  • The intermediate incorporating ring A is prepared from commercially available reagents employing standard organic chemistry techniques. For example, when ring A is thiazole, the intermediate may be prepared according to scheme 3.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00052
  • wherein Q, Y, R1, R6, and R6′ are as defined herein and Pr is an amine protecting group. A proline analogue wherein the alpha nitrogen is protected (Pr), for example with Boc or Cbz, and amidated is converted to the corresponding thioamide, for example using Lawesson's reagent according to the procedures described in Williams et al (J. Org. Chem., 2001, 66:8463). The thiamide is then cyclized with an appropriate bromide to give the desired thiazole substituted with group Q, for example using the procedures described in Ciufolini et al, (J. Org. Chem. 1997, 62: 3804). Alternatively, the bromide in the present scheme may incorporate a functional group which may be used to couple a desired group Q to the thiazole formed from the cyclization step.
  • For compounds of the invention in which ring A is an oxazole, the intermediate may be prepared according to scheme 4.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00053
  • wherein Q, Y, R1, R6, and R6′ are as defined herein and Pr is an amine protecting group. The starting proline analogue is reacted with an appropriate amine using standard amide forming procedures. The resulting amide is cyclized, for example using Burgess Reagent according to the procedures described in Pihko et al (J. Org. Chem., 1999, 64:652), to give the dihydro-oxazole. The dihydro-oxazole is then reduced to give the desired oxazole substituted with group Q. Alternatively, the amine of the first step in the present scheme may incorporate a functional group in place of Q which may be used directly or indirectly to couple a desired group Q to the thiazole formed from the cyclization step.
  • Compounds of the invention in which R4 or R4′ are other than H may be prepared according to standard organic chemistry techniques, for example by reductive amination in which a starting amino acid residue analog e.g. NH2—CH(R3)—C(O)—OH is reacted with a suitable aldehyde or ketone to give the desired R4 and R4′ substituents. See scheme 5. The resulting R4/R4′ substituted amino acid intermediate can then be conjugated to the next amino acid intermediate or the remainder of the compound using standard peptide coupling procedures.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00054
  • In a particular embodiment, alanine is reacted with 1-methylindole-2-carboxaldehyde and reduced with sodium cyanoborohydride dissolved in 1% HOAc/DMF to give the N-substituted alanine residue which may be used in preparing compounds of the invention. See scheme 6.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00055
  • Alternatively, the reductive amination procedure to introduce R4/R4′ substituents is the final step in the preparation of the compound.
  • When compounds of the invention incorporate R4 or R4′ substituents other than H, they may also be prepared by substitution of a suitable acid intermediate which incorporates a leaving group with a desired amine. For example Br—CH(R3)—C(O)—OH is substituted with an amine R4—NH2 or R4—NH—R4′ according to scheme 7.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00056
  • Alternatively, the substitution reaction introducing R4 or R4′ substituents may be performed as a final step in the preparation of the compound as illustrated in scheme 8.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00057
  • In a particular embodiment, 2-bromopropionic acid is reacted with the following amines dissolved in DMF and bubbled for until substitution is complete to form N-substituted alanine residues:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00058
  • Compounds of the invention in which either X1 or X2 is sulfur, i.e. the compound incorporates a thioamide, may be prepared according to established organic chemistry techniques. For example, compounds in which X2 is sulfur can be prepared according to scheme 9 starting from an Fmoc protected amino acid residue analog NH2—CH(R2)—COOH which is dissolved in THF and cooled to −25° C., with addition of DIPEA followed by addition of isobutylchloroformate. After 10 minutes, the diamine, 4-nitrobenzene-1,2-diamine, is added and the reaction mixture is continuously stirred at −25° C. for 2 hours, then at room temperature overnight. THF is vacuumed off and the mixture is then subjected to flash chromatography using 50% EtOAc/Hexane to yield the product. The Fmoc-alanine derivative, phosphorus pentasulfide and sodium carbonate are mixed in THF and stirred overnight. The solution is concentrated and direct chromatography using 80% EtOAc/Hexane yields the activated thioalanine. The activated thioalanine and sodium nitrite are then mixed in acetic acid and diluted with H2O. The resulting precipitant is filtered and dried to yield the product. The thioalanine is coupled to an A ring substituted proline amino acid residue analog by dissolving both in DMF. The thioamide product may then be deprotected with 20% PIP/DMA for 15 minutes and used to conjugate to the R4/R4′—N—C(R3)(R3′)—COOH. Alternatively the Fmoc-protected thioamide is first coupled to the A ring substituted proline amino acid residue analog followed by Fmoc deprotection and subsequent coupling to the R4/R4′—R4/R4′—N—C(R3)(R3′)—COOH amino acid residue analog.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00059
  • Utility
  • The compounds of the invention inhibit the binding of IAP proteins to caspases, in particular X-IAP binding interaction with caspases 3 and 7. The compounds also inhibit the binding of ML-IAP to Smac protein. Accordingly, the compounds of the invention are useful for inducing apoptosis in cells or sensitizing cells to apoptotic signals, in particular cancer cells. Compounds of the invention are useful for inducing apoptosis in cells that overexpress IAP proteins. Alternatively, compounds of the invention are useful for inducing apoptosis in cells in which the mitochondrial apoptotic pathway is disrupted such that release of Smac from ML-IAP proteins is inhibited, for example by up regulation of Bcl-2 or down regulation of Bax/Bak. More broadly, the compounds can be used for the treatment of all cancer types which fail to undergo apoptosis. Examples of such cancer types include neuroblastoma, intestine carcinoma such as rectum carcinoma, colon carcinoma, familiary adenomatous polyposis carcinoma and hereditary non-polyposis colorectal cancer, esophageal carcinoma, labial carcinoma, larynx carcinoma, hypopharynx carcinoma, tong carcinoma, salivary gland carcinoma, gastric carcinoma, adenocarcinoma, medullary thyroidea carcinoma, papillary thyroidea carcinoma, renal carcinoma, kidney parenchym carcinoma, ovarian carcinoma, cervix carcinoma, uterine corpus carcinoma, endometrium carcinoma, chorion carcinoma, pancreatic carcinoma, prostate carcinoma, testis carcinoma, breast carcinoma, urinary carcinoma, melanoma, brain tumors such as glioblastoma, astrocytoma, meningioma, medulloblastoma and peripheral neuroectodermal tumors, Hodgkin lymphoma, non-Hodgkin lymphoma, Burkitt lymphoma, acute lymphatic leukemia (ALL), chronic lymphatic leukemia (CLL), acute myeloid leukemia (AML), chronic myeloid leukemia (CML), adult T-cell leukemia lymphoma, hepatocellular carcinoma, gall bladder carcinoma, bronchial carcinoma, small cell lung carcinoma, non-small cell lung carcinoma, multiple myeloma, basalioma, teratoma, retinoblastoma, choroidea melanoma, seminoma, rhabdomyo sarcoma, craniopharyngeoma, osteosarcoma, chondrosarcoma, myosarcoma, liposarcoma, fibrosarcoma, Ewing sarcoma and plasmocytoma.
  • Compounds of the invention are useful for sensitizing cells to apoptotic signals. Accordingly, the compounds may be administered prior to, concomitantly with, or following administration of radiation therapy or cytostatic or antineoplastic chemotherapy. Suitable cytostatic chemotherapy compounds include, but are not limited to (i) antimetabolites, such as cytarabine, fludarabine, 5-fluoro-2′-deoxyuiridine, gemcitabine, hydroxyurea or methotrexate; (ii) DNA-fragmenting agents, such as bleomycin, (iii) DNA-crosslinking agents, such as chlorambucil, cisplatin, cyclophosphamide or nitrogen mustard; (iv) intercalating agents such as adriamycin (doxorubicin) or mitoxantrone; (v) protein synthesis inhibitors, such as L-asparaginase, cycloheximide, puromycin or diphtheria toxin; (Vi) topoisomerase I poisons, such as camptothecin or topotecan; (vii) topoisomerase II poisons, such as etoposide (VP-16) or teniposide; (viii) microtubule-directed agents, such as colcemid, colchicine, paclitaxel, vinblastine or vincristine; (ix) kinase inhibitors such as flavopiridol, staurosporin, STI571 (CPG 57148B) or UCN-01 (7-hydroxystaurosporine); (x) miscellaneous investigational agents such as thioplatin, PS-341, phenylbutyrate, ET-18-OCH3, or farnesyl transferase inhibitors (L-739749, L-744832); polyphenols such as quercetin, resveratrol, piceatannol, epigallocatechine gallate, theaflavins, flavanols, procyanidins, betulinic acid and derivatives thereof; (xi) hormones such as glucocorticoids or fenretinide; (xii) hormone antagonists, such as tamoxifen, finasteride or LHRH antagonists. In a particular embodiment, compounds of the present invention are coadministered with a cytostatic compound selected from the group consisting of cisplatin, doxorubicin, taxol, taxotere and mitomycin C. In a particular embodiment, the cytostatic compound is doxorubicin.
  • Another class of active compounds which can be used in the present invention are those which are able to sensitize for or induce apoptosis by binding to death receptors (“death receptor agonists”). Such agonists of death receptors include death receptor ligands such as tumor necrosis factor a (TNF-α), tumor necrosis factor β (TNF-β, lymphotoxin-α), LT-β (lymphotoxin-β), TRAIL (Apo2L, DR4 ligand), CD95 (Fas, APO-1) ligand, TRAMP (DR3, Apo-3) ligand, DR6 ligand as well as fragments and derivatives of any of said ligands. In an embodiment, the death receptor ligand is TNF-α. In a particular embodiment, the death receptor ligand is Apo2L/TRAIL. Furthermore, death receptors agonists comprise agonistic antibodies to death receptors such as anti-CD95 antibody, anti-TRAIL-R1 (DR4) antibody, anti-TRAIL-R2 (DR5) antibody, anti-TRAIL-R3 antibody, anti-TRAIL-R4 antibody, anti-DR6 antibody, anti-TNF-R1 antibody and anti-TRAMP (DR3) antibody as well as fragments and derivatives of any of said antibodies.
  • For the purpose of sensitizing cells for apoptosis, the compounds of the present invention can be also used in combination with radiation therapy. The phrase “radiation therapy” refers to the use of electromagnetic or particulate radiation in the treatment of neoplasia. Radiation therapy is based on the principle that high-dose radiation delivered to a target area will result in the death of reproducing cells in both tumor and normal tissues. The radiation dosage regimen is generally defined in terms of radiation absorbed dose (rad), time and fractionation, and must be carefully defined by the oncologist. The amount of radiation a patient receives will depend on various consideration but the two most important considerations are the location of the tumor in relation to other critical structures or organs of the body, and the extent to which the tumor has spread. Examples of radiotherapeutic agents are provided in, but not limited to, radiation therapy and is known in the art (Hellman, Principles of Radiation Therapy, Cancer, in Principles I and Practice of Oncology, 24875 (Devita et al., 4th ed., vol 1, 1993). Recent advances in radiation therapy include three-dimensional conformal external beam radiation, intensity modulated radiation therapy (IMRT), stereotactic radiosurgery and brachytherapy (interstitial radiation therapy), the latter placing the source of radiation directly into the tumor as implanted “seeds”. These newer treatment modalities deliver greater doses of radiation to the tumor, which accounts for their increased effectiveness when compared to standard external beam radiation therapy.
  • Ionizing radiation with beta-emitting radionuclides is considered the most useful for radiotherapeutic applications because of the moderate linear energy transfer (LET) of the ionizing particle (electron) and its intermediate range (typically several millimeters in tissue). Gamma rays deliver dosage at lower levels over much greater distances. Alpha particles represent the other extreme, they deliver very high LET dosage, but have an extremely limited range and must, therefore, be in intimate contact with the cells of the tissue to be treated. In addition, alpha emitters are generally heavy metals, which limits the possible chemistry and presents undue hazards from leakage of radionuclide from the area to be treated. Depending on the tumor to be treated all kinds of emitters are conceivable within the scope of the present invention.
  • Furthermore, the present invention encompasses types of non-ionizing radiation like e.g. ultraviolet (UV) radiation, high energy visible light, microwave radiation (hyperthermia therapy), infrared (IR) radiation and lasers. In a particular embodiment of the present invention UV radiation is applied.
  • The invention also includes pharmaceutical compositions or medicaments containing the compounds of the invention and a therapeutically inert carrier, diluent or excipient, as well as methods of using the compounds of the invention to prepare such compositions and medicaments. Typically, the compounds of formula I used in the methods of the invention are formulated by mixing at ambient temperature at the appropriate pH, and at the desired degree of purity, with physiologically acceptable carriers, i.e., carriers that are non-toxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed into a galenical administration form. The pH of the formulation depends mainly on the particular use and the concentration of compound, but may range anywhere from about 3 to about 8. Formulation in an acetate buffer at pH 5 is a suitable embodiment. In an embodiment, the inhibitory compound for use herein is sterile. The compound ordinarily will be stored as a solid composition, although lyophilized formulations or aqueous solutions are acceptable.
  • The composition of the invention will be formulated, dosed, and administered in a fashion consistent with good medical practice. Factors for consideration in this context include the particular disorder being treated, the particular mammal being treated, the clinical condition of the individual patient, the cause of the disorder, the site of delivery of the agent, the method of administration, the scheduling of administration, and other factors known to medical practitioners. The “effective amount” of the compound to be administered will be governed by such considerations, and is the minimum amount necessary to inhibit IAP interaction with caspases, induce apoptosis or sensitize a malignant cell to an apoptotic signal. Such amount is may be below the amount that is toxic to normal cells, or the mammal as a whole.
  • Generally, the initial pharmaceutically effective amount of the compound of the invention administered parenterally per dose will be in the range of about 0.01-100 mg/kg, for example about 0.1 to 20 mg/kg of patient body weight per day, with the typical initial range of compound used being 0.3 to 15 mg/kg/day. Oral unit dosage forms, such as tablets and capsules, may contain from about 25 to about 1000 mg of the compound of the invention.
  • The compound of the invention may be administered by any suitable means, including oral, topical, transdermal, parenteral, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intrapulmonary, and intranasal, and, if desired for local treatment, intralesional administration. Parenteral infusions include intramuscular, intravenous, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, or subcutaneous administration. An example of a suitable oral dosage form is a tablet containing about 25 mg, 50 mg, 100 mg, 250 mg, or 500 mg of the compound of the invention compounded with about 90-30 mg anhydrous lactose, about 5-40 mg sodium croscarmellose, about 5-30 mg polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP) K30, and about 1-10 mg magnesium stearate. The powdered ingredients are first mixed together and then mixed with a solution of the PVP. The resulting composition can be dried, granulated, mixed with the magnesium stearate and compressed to tablet form using conventional equipment. An aerosol formulation can be prepared by dissolving the compound, for example 5-400 mg, of the invention in a suitable buffer solution, e.g. a phosphate buffer, adding a tonicifier, e.g. a salt such sodium chloride, if desired. The solution is typically filtered, e.g. using a 0.2 micron filter, to remove impurities and contaminants.
  • EXAMPLES
  • The invention will be more fully understood by reference to the following examples. They should not, however, be construed as limiting the scope of the invention. Reagents and solvents were obtained from commercial sources and used as received. ISCO chromatography refers to use of a pre-packed silica gel columns on a Companion system by Teledyne-Isco, Inc. Lincoln, Nebr. The identity and purity of all compounds were checked by LCMS and 1H NMR analysis.
  • Abbreviations Used Herein are as Follows:
  • ACN: acetonitrile;
    Chg: cyclohexylglycine;
    DCM: dichloromethane
    DIPEA: diisopropylethylamine;
    DMAP: 4-dimethylaminopyridine;
    DME: 1,2-dimethoxyethane;
    DMF: dimethylformamide;
    DMSO: dimethylsulfoxide
    EDC: 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide;
    EEDQ: 2-ethoxy-1-ethoxycarbonyl-1,2-dihydroquinoline
    LCMS: liquid chromatography mass spectrometry;
    HATU: O-(7-Azobenzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate;
  • HOBt: N-Hydroxybenzotriazole
  • HBTU: 2-(1H-Benzotriazol-1-yl)-1,1,3,3-Tetramethyl-uronium Hexafluorophosphate
    HPLC: high performance liquid chromatography;
  • NBS: N-bromosuccinamide;
  • TASF: tris(dimethylamino)sulfonium difluorotrimethylsilicate;
    TEA: triethylamine;
    TFA: trifluoroacetate;
    THF: tetrahydrofuran;
  • Example 1 2-[tert-Butoxycarbonyl-(1H-pyrrol-2-ylmethyl)-amino]-propionic Acid
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00060
  • Alanine ethyl ester b (5 g, 32.5 mmol), pyrrole-2-carboxaldehyde a (3.1 g, 32.5 mmol), sodium cyanoborohydride (2.04 g, 32.5 mmol) and AcOH (1%) were mixed in DMF and stirred overnight. The reaction was quenched with H2O, and DMF was evaporated. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed by 0.1N NaOH, dried and concentrated to yield product c 2.5 g. The resulting ester c (2.5 g, 12.8 mmol), di-tert-butyldicarbonate (3.06 g, 14 mmol) were mixed in THF, H2O with NaHCO3 and stirred overnight. THF was evaporated, and the mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed by 1N NaOH, sat. NH4Cl and brine. After dried, the mixture was concentrated to yield the Boc-protected ester d 3.3 g. The Boc-protected ester d (1.67 g, 5.6 mol), lithium hydroxide mono hydrate (284 mg, 6.77 mmol) were mixed in THF and H2O at 0° C. THF was vacuumed off, and the solution was acidified by dilute H2SO4, extracted by EtOAc twice. Organic layers were combined, dried and evaporated giving product 2-[tert-butoxycarbonyl-(1H-pyrrol-2-ylmethyl)-amino]-propionic acid e.
  • Example 2 Thiazole Substituted Pyrrolidine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00061
  • Following the general procedure of Williams (Williams, D. R. et al, M. J. Org. Chem. 2001, 66, 8463), a mixture of N-Cbz-proline amide a (500 mg, 2.0 mmol) Lawesson's reagent (420 mg, 1.05 mmol) and toluene (5 mL) was heated at reflux for 2 h. The solution was concentrated, adsorbed onto Celite, and purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, 40% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 393 mg (74%) of compound b as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00062
  • Following the general procedure of Ciufolini (Ciufolini, M. A. et al, J. Org. Chem. 1997, 62, 3804), ethyl bromopyruvate (200 μl, 1.43 mmol) was added to a suspension of thioamide b (378 mg, 1.43 mmol) in ethanol (5 mL), and the mixture heated at 80° C. for 5 min. The solvent was evaporated under reduced pressure, and the residue purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, gradient elution, 30-40-50% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 393 mg (74%) of thiazole c as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00063
  • Phenyl magnesium bromide (2.1 mL of 1.0 M solution in THF, 2.1 mmol) was added dropwise to a cold (−78° C.) solution of ester c (360 mg, 1.0 mmol) in THF (5 mL) over 5 min. The cooling bath was removed and the solution allowed to reach room temperature, at which time it was poured into saturated aqueous NH4Cl (50 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes (3×10 mL). The combined organic layers were dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, gradient elution, 30-40% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 404 mg (84%) of thiazole d as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00064
  • Triethylsilane (850 μl, 5.3 mmol) and TFA (5 mL) were added sequentially to alcohol d, and the resulting solution was allowed stand at rt for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated, and the residue purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, 30% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford a quantitative yield of compound e as a colorless oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00065
  • Following the general procedure of Thurston (Bose, S. D.; Thurston, D. E. Tetrahedron Lett. 1990, 31, 6903), BF3.Et2O (0.78 mL, 6.2 mmol) was added to a solution of carbamate e (280 mg, 0.62 mmol), propanethiol (560 μl, 6.2 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (3 mL) at rt. After 1 day at rt, the reaction was poured into 1 N NaOH (50 mL) and stirred vigorously for 1 h. The layers were separated and the organic phase was washed with 1 N NaOH (2×5 mL). The combined aqueous layers were extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×5 mL), and the combined organic layers were dried (K2CO3), filtered and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, gradient elution, 40-50-60% ethyl acetate-hexanes, 1% TEA) to afford 122 mg (61%) of amine f as a colorless solid.
  • Example 3 Oxazole Substituted Pyrrolidine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00066
  • A mixture of N-Boc-proline a (5.35 g, 24.9 mmol) serine methyl ester hydrochloride b (3.50 g, 22.5 mmol), EDC (4.76 g, 24.85 mmol), DIPEA (4.0 mL, 22.5 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (90 mL) was maintained overnight. The mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2 (200 mL) and washed with 1 N HCl (3×100 mL), 0.1 N NaOH (3×100 mL) and brine (1×100 mL). The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 5.2 g (73%) of dipeptide c as a colorless foam.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00067
  • To a cool (0° C.) solution of dipeptide c (4.57 g, 14.4 mmol) and THF (100 mL) was added Burgess Reagent (Pihko, P. M.; Koskinen, A. M. P.; Nissinen, M. J.; Rissanen, K. J. Org. Chem. 1999, 64, 652, and references therein) (3.77 g, 15.8 mmol) in 3 portions over 30 min. The cooling bath was removed and the reaction allowed to reach rt, then heated at reflux for 1 h. After cooling to rt, the THF was removed under reduced pressure and the residue was partitioned between EtOAc (200 mL) and saturated aqueous NH4Cl (200 mL). The organic layer was washed with saturated aqueous NH4Cl (2×50 mL). The combined aqueous phases were extracted with EtOAc (1×50 mL) and the combined organic phases were washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, 50-75-100% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 2.94 g (68%) of compound d as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00068
  • Following the general procedure of Koskinen (Pihko, P. M.; Koskinen, A. M. P.; Nissinen, M. J.; Rissanen, K. J. Org. Chem. 1999, 64, 652, and references therein), to degassed CH2Cl2 (25 mL), was added CuBr (8.79 g, 39.3 mmol), hexamethylene tetraamine (5.51 g, 39.3 mmol) and DBU (5.9 mL, 39.3 mmol) and the resulting dark mixture stirred vigorously while it was cooled to 0° C. To this mixture was added a degassed solution of d (2.94 g, 9.83 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (25 mL) over 5 min. The cooling bath was removed and the mixture stirred vigorously for 2 h. The reaction was then poured into 1:1 saturated aqueous NH4Cl: conc. NH4OH (200 mL), stirred for 30 min, then extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with saturated aqueous NH4Cl (2×50 mL), brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO—2, 40-50% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 1.1 g (38%) of oxazole e as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00069
  • Phenylmagnesium bromide (4.4 mL of 1.0 M solution in THF, 4.4 mmol) was added dropwise to a cold (−78° C.) solution of ester e (600 mg, 2.0 mmol) in THF (10 mL) over 5 min. The cooling bath was removed and the solution allowed to reach rt, at which time it was poured into saturated aqueous NH4Cl (50 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes (3×10 mL). The combined organic layers were dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, gradient elution, 20-30-40% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 443 mg (52%) of oxazole f as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00070
  • Triethylsilane (20 μl) and TFA (1 mL) were added sequentially to a solution of alcohol f (50 mg, 0.1 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (1 mL). The resulting solution was allowed stand at rt for 1 h. The solvent was evaporated, and the residue partitioned between EtOAc (20 mL) and 1N NaOH (20 mL). The organic phase was washed with 1N NaOH (2×20 mL). The combined aqueous phases were extracted with EtOAc (1×20 mL), and the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×20 mL) dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford amine g as a colorless oil, contaminated with residual triethylsilane. This material was used directly in the next coupling.
  • Example 4 Synthesis of Methyl Ketones
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00071
  • A mixture of dihydrobezofuran a (Davies, H. M. L.; Grazini, M. V. A.; Aouad, E. Org. Lett. 2001, 3, 1475) (160 mg, 0.9 mmol) DDQ (300 mg) and CH2Cl2 (11 mL) was maintained at room temp. for 2 days. The solution was diluted with 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes and washed with 0.5 N NaOH (3×10 mL), brine (1×10 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 150 mg (93%) of bezofuran b.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00072
  • Isopropylmagnesium chloride (7.1 mL of a 2.0 M solution in THF, 14.2 mmol) was added dropwise to a mixture of benzofuran methyl ester b (500 mg, 2.84 mmol) and N,O-dimethyl hydroxyl amine hydrochloride (690 mg, 7.1 mmol) and THF (8 mL) maintained <−20° C. The mixture was allowed to warm to 0° C. over 20 min, then poured into 50 mL of saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 577 mg (85%) of amide c, as a clear oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00073
  • To a solution of amide c (660 mg, 3.22 mmol) and THF (6 mL) was added MeMgBr (3 mL of a 3.0 M solution in THF, 9 mmol) at 0° C. The solution was maintained at 0° C. for 30 min, then allowed to warm to 20° C. for 30 min, at which time a precipitate forms. The mixture was poured into 100 mL of saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 460 mg (89%) of ketone d, as a clear oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00074
  • A mixture of potassium tert-butoxide (2.2 g, 17.5 mmol), fluoro ketone e (3.0 g, 15.9 mmol) and ethylene glycol (30 mL) was heated at 50° C. for 1 h, then 60° C. for 2 h. The mixture was then poured into 500 mL of saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous phase was extracted with Et2O (3×150 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with water (3×150 mL), brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4). The mixture was adsorbed onto Celite, and chromatographed (ISCO, 120 g silica column, 10-60% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 2.23 g (61%) of the hydroxy ether f as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00075
  • A mixture of potassium cyanide (6.9 g, 106 mmol), fluoro ketone e (2.0 g, 10.6 mmol) and DMSO (20 mL) was maintained at rt for 4 days, then heated at 50° C. for 1 day. The mixture was then poured into 500 mL of 1 N NaOH. The aqueous phase was extracted with Et2O (3×150 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with water (3×150 mL), brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4). The mixture was adsorbed onto Celite, and chromatographed (ISCO, 120 g silica column, 0-20% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 1.15 g (55%) of the nitrile g as a yellow solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00076
  • A mixture of dibromide h (2.33 g, 7.78 mmol), NaSMe (600 mg, 8.56 mmol), and EtOH (5 mL) was maintained at rt 18 h. The mixture was poured into 75 mL of 1 N NaOH and extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with 1 N NaOH (1×50 mL), brine (3×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated to afford 2.06 g (98%) of thioether i as a colorless oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00077
  • To a −78° C. solution of bromide i (500 mg, 1.87 mmol) and THF (15 mL) was added sec-BuLi (1.6 mL of 1.4 M solution in cyclohexane, 2.25 mmol) over 5 min. After 5 min at −78° C., the dark purple solution was quenched rapidly with DMF (0.5 mL) and the solution warmed to 0° C. and maintained at that temp. for 5 min. The solution was then poured into saturated aqueous NH4Cl (50 mL). The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×25 mL), the combined organic phases were washed brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4) and filtered. The mixture was adsorbed onto Celite, and chromatographed (ISCO, 12 g silica column, 0-10% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 260 mg (64%) of aldehyde j as a clear oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00078
  • To a solution of aldehyde j (400 mg, 1.86 mmol) and THF (5 mL) was added MeMgCl (0.9 mL of a 3.0M solution in THF, 2.8 mmol) at 0° C. The solution was maintained at 0° C. for 30 min, then allowed to warm to 20° C. for 30 min. The mixture was poured into 50 mL of saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×25 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford crude alcohol k as a clear oil, which was used without further purification.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00079
  • To a solution of crude sulfide k and MeOH (5 mL) at 0° C. was added a suspension of Oxone (1.3 g, 2.1 mmol) in water (5 mL) over 20 min. The mixture was allowed to reach room temp and then poured into 50 mL of saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×25 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. This residue was dissolved in MeOH (10 mL), cooled to 0° C., and to it was added a suspension of Oxone (2.6 g, 4.2 mmol) in water (10 mL) over 20 min. The mixture was stirred at rt overnight then poured into 50 mL of saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×25 mL), the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 550 mg (100% for two steps) of sulfone l as a clear oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00080
  • A mixture of alcohol l (550 mg, 2.1 mmol), Celite (680 mg), and PCC (500 mg, 2.31 mmol) was stirred vigorously at rt for 6 h. More PCC (200 mg) was added and the mixture was stirred overnight. The mixture was adsorbed onto more Celite (5 g) and chromatographed (ISCO, 12 g silica column 0-50% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 380 mg (69%) of ketone m as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00081
  • Thionyl chloride (26 mL, 365 mmol) was added to a mixture of 2-methoxy-1-naphthoic acid n (4.5 g, 22.3 mmol) and toluene (45 mL). The resulting mixture was heated at 75° C. for 3 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and the intermediate acid chloride was dried under high vacuum for 1 h. It was dissolved in THF (50 mL) and cooled to 0° C. under N2. Dimethylzinc (45 mL of 1.0 M solution in heptane, 44.6 mmol) was added over 15 min. The reaction mixture was kept at 0° C. for 5 min, allowed to warm to room temperature. The reaction was quenched with slow addition of saturated NH4Cl (200 mL). The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×100 mL), and the combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (5-15% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 1.96 g (44%) of ketone o as a white solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00082
  • Following the general procedure of Caldwell (Ichinose, N.; Mizuno, K.; Otsuji, Y.; Caldwell, R. A.; Helms, A. M. J. Org. Chem. 1998, 63, 3176-84), to a solution of CH3MgCl (3.4 mL of 3.0 M solution in THF, 10.0 mmol) in THF (20 mL) was added dropwise a solution of 4-methoxy-1-naphthalenecarbonitrile p (0.5 g, 2.7 mmol) in toluene (10 mL). After the addition, toluene (10 mL) was added to the mixture. The resulting solution was heated to reflux for 8 h. Aqueous AcOH (50%, 10 mL) was added, and the mixture was heated to reflux for 4 h. After cooling, the mixture was diluted with water, and the organic phase separated, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 0.5 g (93%) of ketone q as a yellow oil, which was used without further purification.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00083
  • Following the general procedure of Boswell (Boswell, E. G.; Licause, J. F. J. Org. Chem. 1995, 60, 6592-94), to a solution of sodium thiomethoxide (0.41 g, 5.8 mmol) in anhydrous DMSO (8 mL) at 0° C. under N2 was added dropwise a solution of 4-fluoro-1-acetylnaphthalene e (1.0 g, 5.3 mmol) in DMSO (8 mL). After stirring at room temperature for 1.5 h, the mixture was diluted with water, extracted with CH2Cl2 (3×20 mL), and the combined organic phases were dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 1.0 g (88%) of sulfide r as a light yellow solid, which was carried on without further purification.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00084
  • Following the general procedure of Trost (Trost, B. M.; Curran, D. P. Tetrahedron Lett. 1981, 22, 1287-90), to a cold (0° C.) solution of sulfide r (2.3 g, 10.6 mmol) in methanol (50 mL) was added dropwise a solution of potassium hydrogen persulfate (Oxone, 22.8 g, 37.1 mmol) in water (75 mL) keeping the reaction temperature below 5° C. The resulting slurry was stirred at room temperature for 72 h, diluted with water and extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×100 mL). The combined organics were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford crude product. The residue was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (10-40% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 2.32 g (88%) of sulfone s as an off white solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00085
  • A mixture of 4-fluoro-1-acetylnaphthalene e (4.75 g, 25.2 mmol), morpholine (6.60 mL, 75.8 mmol), K2CO3 (5.21 g, 37.8 mmol), DMSO (30 mL), and water (12 mL) was heated at 90° C. for 8 h. The reaction mixture was diluted with water, extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×100 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford crude product. It was triturated with water, filtered, washed with water, dried to afford 6.40 g (99%) of morpholinyl ketone t as a yellow solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00086
  • 2′-Hydroxy-1′-acetonaphthone u (5.0 g, 26.9 mmol) and K2CO3 (11.1 g, 81.0 mmol) in acetone (150 mL) were stirred for 20 min. To this mixture was added bromoethyl methyl ether (3.8 mL, 39.5 mmol) and catalytic KI. The resulting mixture was heated to reflux for 72 h. After cooling, the solvent was removed in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in EtOAc, washed with 1 N aqueous NaOH, brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (5-25% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 3.21 g (49%) of ether v as an oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00087
  • Following the general procedure of Short (Short, W. F.; Wang, H. J. Chem. Soc. 1950, 991-4), to a three-necked round-bottomed flask equipped with a reflux condenser, a dropping funnel, and an aqueous NaOH trap was added 1-naphthoic acid w (10.0 g, 58.0 mmol) and AcOH (35 mL). This solution was heated at 110° C. and stirred during the addition of bromine (3.12 mL, 61.0 mmol). After the addition, the mixture was heated for another 1.5 h (A yellow solid precipitated during the heating), and then stirred at room temperature for 24 h. The mixture was poured into ice water. The solid was filtered, washed with water, and crystallized from acetic acid (250 mL) to afford 8.9 g (61%) of bromo acid x as a white solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00088
  • A solution of bromo acid x (6.0 g, 23.9 mmol), N,O-dimethylhydroxyl amine hydrochloride (2.33 g, 23.9 mmol), EDC (4.6 g, 23.9 mmol), and DIPEA (6.3 mL, 35.8 mmol) in DMF (35 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 4 h. The mixture was poured into water, extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×200 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with 0.5 N aqueous HCl, 0.5 N aqueous NaOH, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (2-10% ethyl acetate-CH2Cl2) to afford 4.6 g (65%) of amide y as an oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00089
  • Methylmagnesium chloride (8.5 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 25.5 mmol) was added dropwise to a cold (0° C.) solution of amide z (2.5 g, 8.5 mmol) and THF (80 mL). The resulting solution was stirred at 0° C. for 1 h, then allowed to warm to room temperature. After 2.5 h, it was quenched by slow addition of aqueous AcOH (50%, 10 mL), diluted with water (100 mL), and separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (1×100 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 1.9 g (90%) of ketone a′ as a yellow solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00090
  • A mixture of 2′-hydroxy-1′-acetonaphthone u (5.0 g, 26.9 mmol), K2CO3 (7.41 g, 53.7 mmol), and 1-bromo-2-chloroethane (4.4 mL, 53.7 mmol) in DMF (70 mL) was heated at 80° C. for 24 h. The cooled mixture was diluted with water, and extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×100 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with 0.5 N aqueous NaOH, brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford crude product. The residue was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (5-25% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 1.6 g (24%) of chloroethoxy ketone b′ as a light yellow solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00091
  • A mixture of chloroethoxy ketone b′ (3.0 g, 12.1 mmol), benzoic acid (1.47 g, 12.1 mmol), and Cs2CO3 (4.73 g, 14.5 mmol) in DMF (25 mL) was heated at 50° C. for 16 h. Benzoic acid (0.735 g, 6.0 mmol) and Cs2CO3 (2.36 g, 7.2 mmol) were added, and the mixture heated at 80° C. for 24 h. The mixture was filtered, diluted with EtOAc (100 mL), washed with water, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 3.95 g (98%) of ketone c′ as a yellow oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00092
  • Following the general procedure of Oda (Oda, M.; Yamamuro, A.; Watabe, T. Chem. Lett. 1979, 1427-30), Trimethylsilyl cyanide (4.5 mL, 34.1 mmol) was added slowly into a mixture of 5-methoxy-1-tetralone d′ (5.0 g, 28.4 mmol), catalytic ZnI2 in toluene (12 mL). The resulting mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 h. Pyridine (40 mL) and POCl3 (8.0 mL, 85.2 mmol) were added, and the mixture was heated to reflux for 8 h. The cooled dark solution was poured into ice water (300 mL) and conc. HCl (10 mL) with stirring, extracted with EtOAc (3×400 mL). The combined organic layers were washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 4.78 g of crude unsaturated nitrile e′ as a brown solid.
  • A mixture of the above unsaturated nitrile e′ (4.78 g, 25.8 mmol) and DDQ (5.86 g, 25.8 mmol) in toluene (100 mL) was heated at 100° C. for 3.5 h. After cooling, the precipitate was removed by filtration, and washed with toluene. The combined toluene layers were washed with 0.5 N NaOH (2×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to afford 4.22 g (81%) of nitrile f′ as a yellow solid, which was carried on without further purification.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00093
  • Following the general procedure for conversion of p to q, nitrile f′ (2.20 g, 12.0 mmol) afforded 1.64 g (68%) of ketone g′ as a brown oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00094
  • (2-Chloroethoxy)trimethylsilane (8.70 mL, 53.8 mmol) was added to the mixture of 2′-hydroxy-1′-acetonaphthone u (5.0 g, 26.9 mmol), KOH (3.0 g, 53.8 mmol) in DMSO (60 mL) and water (20 mL). The resulting mixture was heated at 80° C. for 24 h. The mixture was diluted with water (400 mL). The crystalline precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with water, dried to afford 5.21 g (84%) of hydroxy ketone h′ as a brown solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00095
  • Bromine (610 μl, 11.9 mmol) was added over 10 min to a solution of hydroxy ketone h′ (2.50 g, 10.9 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (30 mL) and AcOH (8.0 mL) at room temperature. After 2 h, it was quenched with 10% aqueous Na2S2O3 (5 mL), diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 mL). The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with 50 mL of CH2Cl2. The combined organics were washed with 0.5 N aqueous NaOH until the aqueous washes are basic, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 3.70 g (96%) of bromo ketone i′ as a dark brown oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00096
  • A mixture of 2-methoxyethanol (3.35 mL, 42.5 mmol) and potassium t-butoxide (4.76 g, 42.5 mmol) in THF (80 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 10 min. To this mixture was added dropwise a solution of 4-fluoro-1-acetylnaphthalene (4.0 g, 21.3 mmol) in THF (20 mL), and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 h. The mixture was diluted with water (50 mL), and the phases separated. The organic layer was washed with 0.5 N NaOH, brine, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 5.6 g (106%, excess wt. is solvent) of ketone j′ as a brown liquid which solidified under high vacuum.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00097
  • Following the general procedure of Tagat (Tagat, J. R.; McCombie, S. W.; Nazareno, D. V.; Boyle, C. D.; Kozlowski, J. A.; Chackalamannil, S.; Josien, H.; Wang, Y.; Zhou, G. J. Org. Chem. 2002, 67, 1171-77), a suspension of the bromo acid x (3.0 g, 12.0 mmol) in toluene (18 mL) was heated at 80° C. To this reaction mixture was added dropwise N,N-dimethylformamide di-tert-butyl acetal (10.0 mL, 42 mmol), and the resulting mixture was heated for an additional 30 min. It was cooled to rt, washed with water, saturated aqueous NaHCO3, brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo to afford 2.87 g (78%) of t-butyl ester k′ as a yellow oil, which was carried on without further purification.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00098
  • Following the general procedure of Tagat, a stirred solution of t-butyl ester k′ (1.4 g, 4.5 mmol) in anhydrous THF (30 mL) was cooled to −78° C. under N2. n-BuLi (3.65 mL of 1.6 M solution in hexane, 5.85 mmol) was added, and the resulting solution was stirred for 2 min, followed by addition of a solution of N-fluorobenzenesulfonimide (2.83 g, 9.0 mmol) in THF (10 mL). After stirring at −78° C. for 30 min, the reaction was quenched at −78° C. with saturated aqueous NH4Cl. The aqueous layer was extracted with Et2O (2×50 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated in vacuo. The crude material was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (2-20%, EtOAc-hexane) to afford 0.57 g (52%) of fluoro compound l′ as colorless liquid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00099
  • Trifluoroacetic acid (3.85 mL, 50 mmol) was added to a stirred solution of fluoro compound l′ (1.23 g, 5.0 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (50 mL) at rt. After stirring for 3 h, the solution was concentrated in vacuo to afford 0.95 g (100%) of fluoro acid m′ as an oil, which was carried on.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00100
  • A mixture of fluoro acid m′ (820 mg, 4.3 mmol), N,O-dimethylhydroxyl amine hydrochloride (420 mg, 4.3 mmol), EDC (825 mg, 4.3 mmol), and DIPEA (750 μl, 4.3 mmol) in DMF (12 mL) was stirred at rt for 3 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (50 mL), washed with 10% citric acid, 0.5 N NaOH, dried (MgSO4), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (2-10%, EtOAc-hexane) to afford 0.48 g (48%) of fluoro amide n′ as an oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00101
  • To a solution of fluoro amide n′ (1.07 g, 4.6 mmol) in THF at 0° C. was added dropwise a solution of CH3MgCl (4.6 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 13.8 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 1 h, then 2 h at rt. The mixture was quenched with 50% aqueous AcOH (10 mL), diluted with water (50 mL), EtOAc (50 mL), and separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (50 mL). The combined EtOAc layers were dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 0.77 g (89%) of fluoro ketone o′ as an oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00102
  • Following the general procedure of Coudret (Hortholary, C.; Coudret, C. J. Org. Chem. 2003, 68, 2167-74), to a solution of 4-amino-1-naphthalenecarbonitrile p′ (5.0 g, 29.7 mmol) in conc. HCl (50 mL) at 0° C. was carefully added sodium nitrite (3.07 g, 44.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 1 h, then transferred into an additional funnel, and added dropwise to an ice-cold solution of CuCl (5.3 g, 53.5 mmol) in water (150 mL). After addition, CH2Cl2 (80 mL) was added to the reaction mixture. The resulting mixture was allowed to warm to rt and was stirred for 4 h. The mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2, and the phases separated. The aqueous phase was carefully extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×150 mL). The combined CH2Cl2 phases were washed once with saturated sodium thiosulfate, dried (MgSO4), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (2-12%, EtOAc-hexane) to afford 2.63 g (46%) of chloro compound q′ as white solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00103
  • Following the general procedure for conversion of p to q, chloro compound q′ (2.63 g, 14.1 mmol) afforded 2.1 g (74%) of chloro ketone r′ as a yellow liquid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00104
  • Following the procedure of Hallberg (Alterman, M.; Hallberg, A. J. Org. Chem. 2000, 68, 7984-89) a mixture of bromo ketone x (1.40 g, 5.62 mmol), Zn(CN)2 (790 mg, 6.74 mmol), Pd(PPh3)4 (216 mg, 0.19 mmol) and DMF (8 mL) was heated in a microwave reactor (Emry's Optimizer) in a sealed heavy-walled tube at 180° C. for 5 min. After cooling, it was diluted with water (30 mL), extracted with EtOAc (50 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (5-20%, EtOAc-hexane) to afford 900 mg (83%) of nitrile ketone s′ as white solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00105
  • Following the procedure of Leadbeater (Arvela, R.; Leadbeater, N. E. SynLett. 2003, 8, 1145-48), a mixture of bromo ketone x (100 mg, 0.40 mmol), NiCl2 (103 mg, 0.80 mmol) and DMF (2 mL) was heated in a microwave reactor (Emry's Optimizer) in a sealed heavy-walled tube at 200° C. for 8 min. After cooling, it was diluted with water (15 mL), extracted with EtOAc (20 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 4 g column (5-15%, EtOAc-hexane) to afford 55 mg (68%) of chloro ketone t′ as off white solid.
  • Example 5 Bromination of Methyl Ketones and Preparation of Thiazoles
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00106
  • Bromine (260 μl, 5.07 mmol), was added over 20 min to a solution of ketone a (784 mg, 4.6 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (10 mL). The solution was maintained at rt for 1 h, then quenched with 10% aqueous Na2S2O3 (10 mL) and stirred vigorously for 20 min. The layers were separated and the organic phase washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (1×10 mL), brine (1×10 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford 1.15 g of bromo ketone b as a yellow oil. Analysis by 1H NMR indicates a 70:15:15 mixture of product to starting ketone and dibrominated material.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00107
  • A particular procedure: A mixture of Boc-proline-amide c (8.4 g, 39.2 mmol), Lawesson's reagent (8.25 g, 20.4 mmol) and toluene was heated at 50° C. for 1 h (use of higher temperatures results in loss of enantiopurity). The mixture was then adsorbed onto Celite, and purified by chromatography (ISCO, 120 g silica column, gradient elution 10-70% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 7.6 g (84%) of the thioamide d as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00108
  • A particular procedure for thiazole formation: A mixture of thioamide d (7.81 g, 34 mmol), bromoketone b (7.05 g, 80% pure by 1H NMR, 22.6 mmol), pyridine (1.76 mL, 20.3 mmol) and ethanol (75 mL) was heated at 80° C. for 1 h. The ethanol was removed under reduced pressure, and the residue was adsorbed onto Celite. The residue was chromatographed (SiO2, gradient elution 0-2.5-5% EtOAc/CH2Cl2) to afford 6.3 g (73%) of thiazole e as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00109
  • A mixture of bromide f (145 mg, 0.33 mmol), PhB(OH)2 (107 mg, 0.88 mmol), K2CO3 (825 μl of 2.0 M aqueous solution, 1.65 mmol), Pd(PPh3)4 (15 mg, 0.13 mmol), and 20% EtOH-toluene (2.5 mL) was maintained at 80° C. for 3 h. The mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2 (10 mL), and washed with 1 N NaOH (2×5 mL). The combined aqueous layers were extracted with CH2Cl2 (1×10 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×10 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and purified by flash chromatography (SiO2, 10-15-20% acetone-hexanes) to afford 74 mg (52%) of thiazole g as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00110
  • Thiazole e (70 mg, 0.18 mmol) in 1:1 dichloromethane:hexanes (1.5 mL), was treated with N-chlorosuccinimide (30 mg 0.22 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at rt for 2 h, at which point additional NCS (10 mg) was added and the mixture stirred overnight. Celite was added, and the dichloromethane was removed under reduced pressure. The product was purified by chromatography (ISCO, 12 g silica column, gradient elution 0-30% EtOAc/hexanes) to afford 70 mg (99%) of chlorothiazole h.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00111
  • Thiazole e (120 mg, 0.31 mmol) in dichloromethane (1.5 mL), was treated with N-bromosuccinimide (65 mg 0.37 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature for 3 h. After this period, Celite was added, and the dichloromethane was removed under reduced pressure. The product was purified by chromatography (ISCO, 12 g silica column, column was first flushed with CH2Cl2 for 7 minutes and then a gradient of 0-9% EtOAc/CH2Cl2 gradient over 9 minutes.) to afford 128 mg (90%) of bromide i.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00112
  • Following literature precedent ((1) Maguire, M. P.; Sheets, K. R.; McVety, K.; Spada, A. P.; Zilberstein, A. J. Med. Chem. 1994, 37, 2129-2137; (2) Moreno, I.; Tellitu, I.; Dominguez, E.; SanMartin, R.; Eur. J. Org. Chem. 2002, 2126-2135) a mixture of bromothiazole i, (280 mg, 0.61 mmol) and alkynylstannane j (Dabdoub, M. J.; Dabdoub, V. B.; Baroni, A. C. M. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 2001, 123, 9694-9695) (250 mg, 0.73 mmol), LiCl (approximately 50 mg, 120 mmol) and toluene (6 mL) was degassed with nitrogen for 30 min. Tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) (28 mg, 0.02 mmol), was added and the mixture was heated at 100° C. 3 h. After cooling, Celite was added to the mixture, and the solvents were removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by chromatography (ISCO, 12 g silica column, column was first flushed with CH2Cl2 for 5 minutes and then a gradient of 0-20% EtOAc/CH2Cl2 gradient over 10 minutes.) to afford 160 mg (60%) of alcohol k.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00113
  • Following literature precedent (Neidlein, R.; Nussbaumer, T Heterocycles, 2000, 52, 349), bromide i (600 mg, 1.3 mmol), TMS-acetylene l (1.8 mL, 13 mmol) and TMG (0.6 mL, 5 mmol), were dissolved in dimethylacetamide (6 mL). This mixture was degassed with nitrogen for 30 min. Bis(triphenylphosphine)palladium dichloride (46 mg, 0.07 mmol) and copper(I) iodide (62 mg, 0.3 mmol) were added and the mixture was sealed and heated at 70-° C. for 30 minutes. The mixture was diluted with ½-saturated ammonium chloride and filtered through a pad of celite. The aqueous mixture was extracted with 70% diethyl ether in hexane (3×20 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, adsorbed on to Celite, and chromatographed (ISCO, 40 g column and a solvent gradient of 0-11% ethyl acetate in hexane after flushing with hexane for 3 minutes). Terminal alkyne product 27 mg (5%) was isolated along with 200 mg of silyl derivative. The TMS group was removed from this material by treatment with potassium carbonate (200 mg) in methanol (5 mL) for 3 hours at rt. Celite and toluene (1 mL) were added to the mixture, and the solvents were removed under reduced pressure. The product was purified by chromatography (ISCO 40 g column, solvent gradient of 0-11% ethyl acetate/hexane after flushing with pure hexane for 3 minutes), to afford a further 110 mg of terminal alkyne m (26% combined).
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00114
  • Terminal alkyne m (50 mg, 0.12 mmol) was dissolved in THF (0.3 mL) and cooled to −78° C. LHMDS (0.15 mL of a 1.0 M solution of in THF, 0.15 mmol) was added dropwise and allowed to stir for 10 minutes. Methyl iodide (0.1 mL, excess) was added, the reaction was stirred for 10 minutes at −78° C. and then allowed to gradually warm to rt, over 45 minutes. Celite was then added to the reaction mixture, the solvents were evaporated under reduced pressure, and the residue purified by chromatography (ISCO, 12 g, column gradient elution 0-18% ethyl acetate in hexane) to afford 25 mg (63%) of the methyl alkyne n.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00115
  • Typical Boc deprotection: Carbamate o (75 mg, 0.18 mmol) was treated with TFA (2 mL) and water (2 drops), in CH2Cl2 (2 mL) for 2 h. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure, the residue dissolved in ethyl acetate (10 mL) and washed with 1 N NaOH (3×3 mL). The combined aqueous layers were extracted with ethyl acetate (1×2 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×3 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to provide quantitative yield of amine p.
  • Example 6 Linear Coupling Procedure
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00116
  • Typical HATU coupling: A mixture of amine a (169 mg, 0.59 mmol), N-Boc-t-butly glycine (150 mg, 0.65 mmol), HATU (450 mg, 1.18 mmol), DIPEA (200 μl, 1.18 mmol) and DMF (2 mL) was maintained at rt for 2 h. The solution was diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL) and washed with 1 N HCl (3×10 mL), 1 N NaOH (3×5 mL), brine (1×10 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (SiO—2, 10-15-20% ethyl acetate-hexanes) to afford 286 mg (97%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00117
  • Following the general Boc deprotection procedure described above, Boc amine b (317 mg, 0.64 mmol) afforded a quantitative yield of amine c as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00118
  • Typical EDC coupling: A solution of amine c (300 mg, 0.76 mmol), N-Boc-alanine (158 mg, 0.84 mmol), EDC (161 mg, 0.84 mmol), catalytic DMAP and MeCN (3 mL) was maintained at rt for 3 h. The solution was diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL) and washed with 1 N HCl (3×10 mL), 1 N NaOH (3×5 mL), brine (1×10 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to provide 453 mg of crude residue d, which was carried on directly:
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00119
  • Typical final Boc removal and purification: The crude residue d from above was treated with TFA (2 mL) and water (2 drops), in CH2Cl2 (2 mL) for 2 h. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by reverse-phase HPLC (C18, MeCN—H2O, 0.1% TFA) and the solvents removed by lyophilization to provide 166 mg (38% for 2 steps) of amine e as a colorless powder.
  • Example 7 N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-cyclohexylglycine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00120
  • A solution of Fmoc-L-cyclohexylglycine (3.6 g, 9.6 mmol) dissolved in DCM (50 mL) and DIPEA (5.6 mL, 32 mmol) was added to 2-chlorotrityl chloride resin (5 g, 8 mmol) and gently agitated for 3 hours at room temperature. The resin was washed with DCM 4 times, DCM/MeOH/DIPEA (17:2:1) 3 times, DCM 3 times, and 2 times dimethylacetamide (DMA). The Fmoc group was removed by treating the resin with 20% piperidine/DMA (50 mL) for 15 minutes. The resin was washed with DMA 6 times. A solution of Boc-N-methylalanine (3.3 g, 16 mmol), HBTU (6.1 g, 16 mmol), and DIPEA (5.6 mL, 32 mmol) and DMA/DCM (1:1, 50 mL) was added to the resin and gently agitated for 2 hours at room temperature. The resin was washed with DMA 5 times, DCM 2 times, and dried under reduced pressure. The dipeptide was cleaved from the resin by gentle agitation with HOAc/TFE/DCM (1:1:3, 100 mL) for 2 hours at room temperature. The resin was removed by filtration and the solution concentrated. Residual AcOH was removed by azeotroping with hexanes (15 times volume). The solid residue was purified by reverse-phase HPLC (C18, MeCN—H2O, 0.1% TFA) and the solvents removed by lyophilization to provide 1.2 g (43%) of dipeptide N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-cyclohexylglycine as a white powder.
  • Example 8 N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-dehydropyranylglycine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00121
  • A mixture of N-Cbz-dehydropyranylglycine methyl ester a (Burk, M. J.; Gross, M. F.; Martinez, J. P. J. Am Chem. Soc. 1995, 117, 9375, and references therein) (5.2 g, 17 mmol), 5% Pd.C (500 mg), MeOH (75 mL) and THF (25 mL) was maintained under an atmosphere of H2 for 24 h. The mixture was filtered through Celite and the Celite washed with MeOH, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford a quantitative yield of amine b as a colorless oil, which was carried on directly.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00122
  • The amine b prepared above was combined with CH2Cl2 (40 mL), saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (40 mL) and cooled to 0° C. Benzyloxy carbonyl chloride (3.0 mL) was then added dropwise and the mixture stirred vigorously overnight. The phases were separated and the aqueous phase extracted with CH2Cl2 (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), filtered, adsorbed onto Celite and chromatographed (ISCO, 120 g silica column, gradient elution 5-55% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 4.15 g (80%) of racemic Cbz-pyranylglycine methyl ester. The enantiomers were separated on a Chiracel OD column eluting with 10% EtOH-hexanes. The desired S-enantiomer c elutes first under these conditions.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00123
  • A mixture of (S)—N-Cbz-pyranyl glycine c methyl ester (2.4 g, 7.82 mmol) 10% Pd.C (700 mg), MeOH (80 mL) was maintained under 1 atmosphere of H2 for 24 h. The mixture was filtered through Celite with MeOH, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 1.35 g (100%) of amine d as a colorless oil. Alternatively, pyranyl glycine can be synthesized in enantiopure form following the procedure of Ghosh (Ghosh, A. K.; Thompson, W. J.; Holloway, M. K.; McKee, S. P.; Duong, T. T.; Lee, H. Y.; Munson, P. M.; Smith, A. M.; Wai, J. M.; Darke, P. L.; Zugay, J. A.; Imini, E. A.; Schleif, W. A.; Huff, J. R.; Anderson, P. S. J. Med. Chem., 1993, 36, 2300).
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00124
  • A mixture of amine d (1.35 g, 7.8 mmol), N-Boc-N-methyl alanine e (1.74 g, 8.6 mmol), EDC (1.65 g 8.8 mmol) and MeCN (50 mL) was maintained at rt overnight. The MeCN was removed under reduced pressure, and the residue diluted with EtOAc, washed with 0.5 N HCl (3×10 mL), 0.5 N NaOH (3×10 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to provide 2.1 g (75%) of protected dipeptide f, as a clear oil.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00125
  • To a 0° C. solution of ester f (2.10 g, 5.86 mmol) and THF (50 mL) were added LiOH.H2O (1.23 g, 29.3 mmol) and water (2 mL). The mixture was maintained at 0° C. for 2 h, then the cooling bath was removed and the mixture was stirred overnight. Most of the THF was then removed under reduced pressure and the residue was diluted with CH2Cl2, washed with 0.5 N HCl, dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated to provide 1.53 g (78%) of dipeptide N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-dehydropyranylglycine g, as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00126
  • A particular procedure for convergent coupling: A mixture of amine h (69 mg, 0.26 mmol), dipeptide N-Boc-N-methyl-L-alanine-L-cyclohexylglycine from example 7 (60 mg, 0.23 mmol), HOAt (Carpino, L. A.; El-Faham, A. Tetrahedron, 1999, 55, 6813) (47 mg, 0.24 mmol), DIC (53 μl, 0.34 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (2 mL) was maintained at rt overnight. The mixture was adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography (ISCO, 4 g silica column, gradient elution 5-50% EtOAc-hexanes) to afford 94 mg of the product i as a colorless solid contaminated with diisopropyl urea. The mixture was carried on directly to the next step.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00127
  • The crude residue i from above was treated with TFA (2 mL) and water (2 drops), in CH2Cl2 (2 mL) for 2 h. The volatiles were removed under reduced pressure. The residue was purified by reverse-phase HPLC (C18, MeCN—H2O, 0.1% TFA) and the solvents removed by lyophilization to provide 77 mg (54% for 2 steps) of amine salt j as a colorless powder.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00128
  • A mixture of the Acetate product k (228 mg, 0.32 mmol), K2CO3 (53 mg, 0.38 mmol) in aqueous methanol (1:2, v:v, 15 mL) was stirred at rt for 1 h. Methanol was removed in vacuo. The residue was diluted with water, extracted with CH2Cl2 (1×50 mL), and the organic phase dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to afford a crude product. Conversion to the amine salt l was accomplished in 18% yield (3 steps) following the general procedure.
  • Example 8
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00129
  • A mixture of acid a (1.5 g, 6.9 mmol) prepared according to the procedures of described in Kice et al. (J. Org. Chem. 1989, 54, 3596-3602), amine HCl salt (868 mg, 8.9 mmol), EDC (1.3 g, 6.9 mmol), and DIPEA (1.2 mL, 6.9 mmol) in DMF (17 mL) was stirred at RT for overnight. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (50 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl, 0.5 N NaOH, dried (MgSO4), filtered, concentrated in vacuo to afford 1.3 g (74%) of amide b as a yellow solid, which was carried on without further purification.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00130
  • 10% Pd/C (200 mg) was added into a solution of acid a (500 mg, 2.3 mmol), NaOH (92 mg, 2.3 mmol) in EtOH (25 mL) and water (5 mL) in a Parr reactor. This mixture was purged with N2 for 10 min, then hydrogenated with a Parr hydrogenator at 50 psi at RT for 2.5 h. The resulting mixture was filtered through Celite, concentrated in vacuo to afford 50 mg (104%) of amine salt b as a greenish-brown solid.
  • Example 10
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00131
  • To a stirred mixture of the amine salt a (500 mg, 2.4 mmol) in 6N HCl (30 mL), cooled at 0° C., was added NaNO2 (248 mg, 3.6 mmol) in one portion (caution was used due to elevated reaction temperature). After stirred at 0° C. for 1 h, this solution was added drop wise, via a dropping funnel, over 20 min to an ice-water cold solution of CuBr (618 mg, 4.3 mmol) in water (30 mL). Then dichloromethane (40 mL) was added to slowly to the reaction mixture (caution was used due to foaming). The resulting mixture was allowed to reach RT and was stirred for 4 h. It was diluted with CH2Cl2 (100 mL), separated, washed the aqueous layer with another portion of CH2Cl2 (100 mL). The combined CH2Cl2 were washed once with sat. aq. Na2S2O3, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (20-100% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 175 mg (29%) of bromo acid b as a light yellow solid.
  • Example 11
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00132
  • A mixture of bromo acid a (680 mg, 2.7 mmol), amine HCl salt (264 mg, 2.7 mmol), EDC (520 mg, 2.7 mmol), and DIPEA (472 μL, 2.7 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) was stirred at RT for overnight. The mixture was partition between water (50 mL) and EtOAc (100 mL), separated, washed the aqueous layer with another portion of EtOAc (100 mL). The combined organic were washed with 1N HCl (50 mL), 1N NaOH (50 mL), dried (MgSO4), filtered, concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (10-50% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 300 mg (38%) of bromo amide b as a yellow oil.
  • Example 12
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00133
  • To a solution of bromo amide a (300 mg, 1.0 mmol) in THF (8 mL) at 0° C. was added drop wise a solution of CH3MgCl (2.0 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 6.0 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred for 1 h, and then allowed to warm to RT for 2 h. The mixture was quenched with 50% aq. AcOH (4 mL), diluted with water (50 mL) and EtOAc (50 mL), separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (50 mL). The combined EtOAc were dried (MgSO4), filtered, and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (2-10% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 150 mg (60%) of bromo ketone b as light yellow oil. Compound b may also be prepared employing the procedures described by Alvaro et al. (WO 2004099143) and Tsuno et al. (Bull Chem. Soc. of Japan 1975, 48(11), 3347-55).
  • Example 13
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00134
  • The starting acid a (6.6 g, 30.4 mmol) was treated with thionyl chloride (50 mL), CHCl3 (50 mL), and 1 drop of DMF at 78° C. for 5 h. The resulting mixture was concentrated in vacuo, dried under high vacuum for overnight. The resulting yellow solid was cooled in an ice-water bath and MeOH (200 mL) was added slowly. This was then refluxed for 1 h. After cooled to RT, the resulting precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with cold MeOH, and dried to afford 5.0 g (71%) of ester b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 14
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00135
  • A suspension of ester a (5.0 g, 21.6 mmol) and 10% Pd/C (1.2 g) in MeOH (200 mL) was purged with N2 for 5 min, then treated with a balloon of H2 at RT until the reaction is completed (checked by LCMS). After purging the reaction mixture with N2 for 10 min, the mixture was filtered through Celite, washed with MeOH, concentrated in vacuo, and high vacuum dried to afford 4.2 g (97%) of amine b as a brown oil.
  • Example 15
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00136
  • A mixture of bromo ketone a (285 mg, 1.1 mmol), Zn(CN)2 (400 mg, 3.4 mmol), and Pd(PPh3)4 (88 mg, 0.076 mmol) in DMF (2 mL) was heated in a microwave at 200° C. for 600 sec. After cooled, diluted with water (10 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×10 mL). The insoluble material was removed by filtration; the solvent was dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (5-20% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 147 mg (66%) of nitrile ketone b as a white solid. Compound a may also be prepared employing the procedures described by Alvaro et al. (WO 2004099143) and Tsuno et al. (Bull Chem. Soc. of Japan 1975, 48(11), 3347-55).
  • Example 16
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00137
  • To a suspension of amine a (4.2 g, 20.9 mmol) in 6 N HCl (100 mL), cooled in ice-water bath, was added NaNO2 (2.2 g, 31.4 mmol) in portions (caution was used due to elevated reaction temperature). After stirred at ice-water temperature for 1 h, this cold solution was added drop wise onto an ice-cold solution of CuBr (5.4 g, 37.6 mmol) in water (150 mL). After addition, CH2Cl2 (80 mL) was added slowly to the mixture. The reaction mixture was allowed to reach RT and was stirred for 4 h. It was diluted with more CH2Cl2 (50 mL). The phases were separated. The aqueous phase was extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×50 mL). The combined CH2Cl2 were washed with sat. sodium thiosulfate (100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (1-8% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 3.1 (66%) of chloro ester b as a white solid.
  • Example 17
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00138
  • Following the general procedure of Williams et al. (Tetrahedron Lett. 1995, 36(31), 5461-5464), to a stirred suspension of ester a (1.5 g, 5.7 mmol) and amine (700 mg, 7.1 mmol) in THF (30 mL) at −5° C. under N2 was added CH3MgCl (16.1 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 48.4 mmol) over 20 min while keeping the temperature below 0° C. After 0.5 h at −5° C., the reaction mixture was allowed to warm to RT and stirred for overnight. The reaction was quenched with 1 N HCl, diluted with 1 N HCl (100 mL), heated the mixture at 35° C. for 3 h, then cooled, diluted with EtOAc (150 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (1-10% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 900 mg (64%) of chloro ketone b as a clear liquid. Compound b may also be prepared employing the procedures described by Alvaro et al. (WO 2004099143) and Tsuno et al. (Bull Chem. Soc. of Japan 1975, 48(11), 3347-55).
  • Example 18
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00139
  • Concentrated sulfuric acid (2 mL) was added slowly to a stirred solution of 2-fluorophenylacetic acid a (10.0 g, 65.0 mmol) in toluene (100 mL) and EtOH (7.6 mL, 130 mmol). The resulting mixture was heated at 100° C. for 1.5 h. It was concentrated in vacuo, diluted with EtOAc (200 mL), washed with 10% K2CO3 until the washes were basic, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to afford 9.9 g (84%) of ester b as a light yellow oil.
  • Example 19
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00140
  • Concentrated sulfuric acid (3 mL) was added slowly to a stirred solution of 2,4 difluorophenylacetic acid a (10.0 g, 58.1 mmol) in EtOH (100 mL), stirred at RT for 2 d. It was concentrated, diluted with EtOAc (200 mL), washed with 10% K2CO3 until the washes were basic, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to afford 11.1 g (95.5%) of difluoro ester b as a white solid.
  • Example 20
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00141
  • Following the procedure for preparing ester from example 19, 2-nitrophenylacetic acid a (10.0 g, 55.2 mmol) afforded 10.9 g (95%) of nitro ester b as a light yellow solid.
  • Example 21
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00142
  • Following the general procedure described by Kemp et al. (J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1975, 97, 7305-7312), reaction of difluoro-ester a (4.0 g, 20.0 mmol), isoamyl-nitrite (3.2 mL, 24.0 mmol), and NaOEt (1.4 g, 20.0 mmol) in EtOH (40 mL), after purified by ISCO CombiFlash 80 g column (2-30% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 2.1 g (47%) of difluoro oxime b as a light yellow solid.
  • Example 22
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00143
  • A solution of the nitro oxime a (5.0 g, 21.0 mmol) prepared according to the procedures described by Kemp et al. (J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1975, 97, 7305-7312) in DMF (30 mL) was added drop wise over 25 min to a vigorously stirred suspension of hexane-washed NaH (60% in mineral oil, 840 mg, 21.0 mmol) in DMF (40 mL) under N2. The resulting dark colored solution was heated slowly to 130° C. for 8 h. It was diluted with water (200 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×200 mL), washed the EtOAc with brine, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (1-10% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 1.6 g (41%) of benzisoxazole b as an off white solid.
  • Example 23
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00144
  • A mixture of benzisoxazole acid a (1.23 g, 7.5 mmol) prepared according to the procedures described by Kemp et al. (J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1975, 97, 7305-7312), amine HCl salt (736 mg, 7.5 mmol), EDC (1.44 g, 7.5 mmol), and DIPEA (1.2 mL, 6.7 mmol) in MeCN (50 mL) was stirred at RT for overnight. It was concentrated in vacuo, dissolved in EtOAc (200 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl and water, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated to afford 1.4 g (88%) of benzisoxazole amide b as an off white solid.
  • Example 24
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00145
  • Following the procedure for preparing bromo ketone from example 12, to benzisoxazole amide a (1.2 g, 5.9 mmol) was added CH3MgCl (6.0 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 17.8 mmol). The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (1-5% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 670 mg (71%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as a white crystalline. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Smalley et al. (Science of Synthesis 2002, 11, 289-335) and Farooq et al. (WO 9614305).
  • Example 25
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00146
  • Bromine (184 μL, 3.6 mmol) was added drop wise to a solution of benzisoxazole ketone a (525 mg, 3.3 mmol) in AcOH (1.5 mL) and CH2Cl2 (6.0 mL). After 1 h at RT, LCMS indicated no reaction. Five drops of conc. HCl were added to the reaction mixture and stirred at RT for overnight. It was quenched with 10% Na2S2O3, diluted with CH2Cl2 (100 mL), washed with 5% NaHCO3, separated, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to afford 820 mg (105%) of bromo ketone b as a brown oil.
  • Example 26
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00147
  • Following the general procedure of Strupczewski et al. (J. Med. Chem. 1985, 28, 761-769), to a suspension of NaH (60% in mineral oil, 37 mg, 0.92 mmol) in THF (3.0 mL) was added drop wise a solution of difluoro oxime a (140 mg, 0.61 mmol) in DMF (1.5 mL). The resulting mixture was heated at 70° C. for 4 h. It was cooled, poured onto water (30 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×50 mL). The EtOAc was washed with water, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (1-5% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 60 mg (47%) of benzisoxazole ester b as an off white solid.
  • Example 27
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00148
  • A suspension of benzisoxazole a (1.6 g, 7.8 mmol) in 70% H2SO4 (30 mL) was heated at 80° C. for 4 h. It was cooled, poured onto crushed ice. The solid was collected by filtration, washed with water, and dried to afford 1.3 g (89%) of benzisoxazole acid b as a white solid.
  • Example 28
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00149
  • Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 23, benzisoxazole acid a (1.3 g, 7.0 mmol) afforded, after purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (2-15% ethyl acetate-hexane), 740 mg (47%) of benzisoxazole amide b as a white solid.
  • Example 29
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00150
  • Following the procedure for preparing of ketone from example 24, benzisoxazole amide a (740 mg, 3.3 mmol) afforded 390 mg (66%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as an off white solid.
  • Example 30
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00151
  • Following the procedure for preparing ester from example 19, 2,5-difluorophenylacetic acid a (9.56 g, 55.6 mmol) afforded 9.24 g (83%) of difluoro ester b as a clear liquid.
  • Example 31
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00152
  • Following the procedure for preparing ester from example 19, 2,3-difluorophenylacetic acid a (10.0 g, 58.1 mmol) afforded 10.8 g (93%) of difluoro ester b as a clear liquid.
  • Example 32
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00153
  • Following the procedure for preparing oxime from example 21, difluoro ester a (9.2 g, 46.0 mmol) afforded 5.57 g (53%) of difluoro oxime b as a white solid.
  • Example 33
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00154
  • Following the procedure for preparing oxime from example 21, difluoro ester a (10.8 g, 54 mmol) afforded 4.9 g (40%) of difluoro oxime b as a white solid.
  • Example 34
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00155
  • Following the procedure for preparing ester from example 26, difluoro oxime a (5.5 g, 24.0 mmol) afforded, after purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (1-5% ethyl acetate-hexane), 2.66 g (53%) of benzisoxazole ester b as an off white solid.
  • Example 35
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00156
  • Following the procedure for preparing ester from example 26, difluoro oxime a (4.9 g, 21.4 mmol) afforded 2.9 g (65%) of benzisoxazole ester b as a light yellow crystalline.
  • Example 36
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00157
  • Following the procedure for preparing acid from example 27, benzisoxazole ester a (2.1 g, 10.0 mmol) afforded 1.92 g (86%) of benzisoxazole acid b as an off white solid.
  • Example 37
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00158
  • Following the procedure for preparing acid from example 27, benzisoxazole ester a (2.4 g, 11.5 mmol) afforded 1.92 g (76%) of benzisoxazole acid b as an off white solid.
  • Example 38
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00159
  • Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 23, benzisoxazole acid a (1.4 g, 7.73 mmol) afforded 1.95 g (83%) of benzisoxazole amide b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 39
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00160
  • (Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 23, benzisoxazole acid a (1.9 g, 10.5 mmol) afforded 1.7 g (72%) of benzisoxazole amide b as a brown solid.
  • Example 40
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00161
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 12, benzisoxazole amide a (1.95 g, 8.7 mmol) afforded 448 mg (30%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as a brown oil. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Farooq et al. (WO 9614305).
  • Example 41
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00162
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 12, benzisoxazole amide a (1.70 g, 7.6 mmol) afforded 192 mg (14%) of benzisoxazole ketone b as a white crystalline solid.
  • Example 42
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00163
  • A suspension of 1,4-naphthalenedicarboxylic acid a (10.0 g, 46.3 mmol) in MeOH (70 mL) and H2SO4 (5 mL) was stirred at RT for 2 days, and then heated at 50° C. for 10 h. It was concentrated in vacuo, re-dissolved in CH2Cl2 (300 mL), washed with 10% K2CO3 (200 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated to give 6.6 g (60%) of di-ester b as yellow solid.
  • Example 43
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00164
  • A mixture of the di-ester a (2.0 g, 8.2 mmol), LiOH (344 mg, 8.2 mmol) in THF (40 mL), water (5 mL), and MeOH (1 mL) was stirred at RT overnight. LCMS indicated some starting di-ester still remains un-reacted. Extra LiOH (84 mg, 2.0 mmol) was added to the reaction mixture. After 4 h, it was diluted with 0.5 N HCl (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (100 mL), dried (MgSO4), concentrated to afford 1.4 g (74%) of monoacid b as a light yellow solid.
  • Example 44
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00165
  • A mixture of monoacid a (1.4 g, 6.1 mmol) and SOCl2 (9 mL) in toluene (15 mL) was heated at 75° C. for 4 h. The solvent was removed in vacuo, diluted with toluene (50 mL) and concentrated, and dried under high vacuum overnight. The residue was suspended in toluene (30 mL) and cooled in ice-water bath. Me2Zn (12 mL of 1 M solution in heptane, 12.0 mmol) was added slowly, stirred at RT for 3.5 h. The reaction was quenched with sat. NH4Cl, diluted with water (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (1-10% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 890 mg (86%) of ketone ester b as an off white solid. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Uehata et al. (JP 2003073357).
  • Example 45
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00166
  • Bromine (1.49 g, 9.3 mmol) was added slowly to a stirred solution of ketone a (1.47 g, 8.5 mmol) prepared according to the procedures described by Berg et al. (WO 02066480) in 33% HBr/AcOH (20 mL) at RT. It was stirred for 1 h, diluted with ether (65 mL), and stirred vigorously for 1 h. The solid was collected by filtration, washed with ether, high vacuum dried to afford 2.88 g (100%) of bromo methyl ketone b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 46
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00167
  • A mixture of 2-hydroxyquinoline-4-carboxylic acid a (6.25 g, 33.1 mmol), MeI (10.33 g, 72.7 mmol), and K2CO3 (10.0 g, 72.7 mmol) in DMF (110 mL) was heated at 80° C. for 16 h overnight. LCMS indicated incomplete reaction. Extra MeI (4.69 g, 33.1 mmol) was added to the reaction mixture and heated at 100° C. for 3 h. It was cooled, poured into ice water, and 10% K2CO3 (50 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×150 mL). The combined EtOAc were washed with water, dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 80 g column (2-50% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 4.68 g (65%) of dihydroquinoline ester b as an off white solid.
  • Example 47
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00168
  • Lithium hydroxide (1.45 g, 34.5 mmol) was added to a solution of dihydroquinoline ester a (1.50 g, 6.91 mmol) in THF (40 mL), followed by water (10 mL). The mixture was stirred at RT for 16 h. It was concentrated in vacuo, diluted with EtOAc (100 mL) and 0.5 N HCl (100 mL). A white solid precipitated and was collected by filtration, washed with water. The EtOAc was separated, dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo to afford a white solid product. A combined yields of 1.41 g (100%) of dihydroquinoline acid b as a white solid, which was used with out further purification.
  • Example 48
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00169
  • N,N-Diisopropylethylamine (1.37 g, 10.7 mmol) was added to a suspension of dihydroquinoline acid a (2.42 g, 11.9 mmol), amine (1.40 g, 14.3 mmol), and EDC (2.28 g, 11.9 mmol) in MeCN (80 mL), stirred at RT for 2 h. It was concentrated in vacuo, diluted with CH2Cl2 (100 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl (50 mL) and 0.5 N NaOH (50 mL), dried (MgSO4), concentrated to afford 1.98 g (67%) of dihydroquinoline amide b as a white solid, which was used with out further purification.
  • Example 49
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00170
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 12, dihydroquinoline amide a (2.17 g, 8.82 mmol), CH3MgCl (8.82 mL of 3 M solution in THF, 26.5 mmol) afforded 766 mg (43%) of dihydroquinoline ketone b as a yellow solid. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Fujita et al. (Chem. & Pharm. Bull 2001, 49(7), 900-904 and Chem. & Pharm. Bull. 2001, 49(4), 407-412).
  • Example 50
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00171
  • Following the general procedure of Legros et al. (Tetrahedron 2001, 57, 2507-2514), 4-bromoisoquinoline a (1.0 g, 4.8 mmol) afforded 707 mg (86%) of ketone b as a light yellow solid.
  • Example 51
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00172
  • Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 48, dihydroisoquinoline acid a (1.25 g, 6.2 mmol) prepared according to the procedures described by Deady et al. (J. Heterocyclic Chem. 2001, 38, 1185) afforded 754 mg (50%) of dihydroisoquinoline amide b as a yellow gum.
  • Example 52
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00173
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 49, dihydroisoquinoline amide a (0.754 g, 3.06 mmol) afforded 510 mg (85%) of dihydroisoquinoline ketone b as a yellow solid. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Alvarez et al. (Science of Synthesis 2005, 15, 839-906), Kimura et al. (Chem. & Pharm. Bull 1983, 31(4), 1277-82), Tomisawa et al. (Chem. & Pharm. Bull 1975, 23(3), 592-6) and Dyke et al. (Tetrahedron 1973, 29(23), 3881-8).
  • Example 53
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00174
  • A mixture of 2-hydroxyquinoline-4-carboxylic acid a (4.0 g, 21.2 mmol), POBr3 (25.0 g, 87.2 mmol) in toluene (40 mL) was heated at 100° C. for 3 h. It was cooled to RT, carefully poured onto crushed ice, extracted with EtOAc (2×250 mL), dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in 1 N NaOH (150 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×100 mL). The aqueous layer was then acidified with 1 N HCl to pH 3. The white solid was collected by filtration, washed with water, dried to afford 3.0 g (56%) of bromo acid b as a white solid.
  • Example 54
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00175
  • Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 48, bromo acid a (3.0 g, 11.9 mmol) afforded 2.67 g (77%) of bromo amide b as a white solid.
  • Example 55
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00176
  • (46801-78) Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 49, bromo amide a (1.0 g, 3.4 mmol) afforded 800 mg (94%) of bromo ketone b as an off white solid.
  • Example 56
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00177
  • Trifluoromethane sulfonic anhydride (6.82 g, 24.2 mmol) was added drop wise onto to a mixture of ethyl-4-hydroxyquinoline carboxylate a (5.0 g, 23.0 mmol) and pyridine (1.95 mL, 24.2 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (100 mL) at ice water bath temperature under N2. The mixture was stirred at RT overnight. It was diluted with CH2Cl2 (100 mL), washed with 0.5 N NaOH (100 mL), dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 80 g column (2-15% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 7.4 g (93%) of triflate b as a white solid.
  • Example 57
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00178
  • Following the general procedure of Legros et al. (Tetrahedron 2001, 57, 2507-2514), a mixture of triflate a (1.0 g, 2.86 mmol), bis(dibenzylideneacetone)palladium(0) (82 mg, 0.14 mmol), 1,3-bis(diphenylphosphino)propane (65 mg, 0.16 mmol), and Et3N (1.19 mL, 8.58 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) were stirred at RT for 15 min under N2. n-Butyl vinyl ether (1.43 g, 14.3 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) was added and the resulting mixture was stirred at 80° C. for 24 h. It was cooled to RT, 1 N HCl (30 mL) were added slowly, stirred at RT for 24 h. The mixture was neutralized with 1 N NaOH and extracted with ether (2×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (2-20% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 460 mg (66%) of ketone b as a white solid.
  • Example 58
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00179
  • A mixture of ketone ester a (1.50 g, 6.17 mmol), KOH (640 mg, 11.35 mmol) in EtOH (30 mL) was stirred at RT overnight. The reaction mixture was diluted with water (150 mL), extracted with EtOAc (100 mL). The aqueous layer was then acidified with 1 N HCl, extracted with EtOAc (2×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo afforded 1.53 g (100%) of ketone acid b as a yellow solid. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Priestly et al. (Bioorg. & Med. Chem. 1996, 4(7), 1135-1147).
  • Example 59
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00180
  • A mixture of the ketone acid a (1.30 g, 5.16 mmol), dimethylamine hydrochloride (480 mg, 5.93 mmol), EDC (1.14 g, 5.93 mmol), and DIPEA (765 mg, 5.93 mmol) in MeCN (30 mL) was stirred at RT overnight. Solvent was removed. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (100 mL), washed with 1 N HCl (50 mL) and 1 N NaOH (50 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (2-20% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane) to afford 656 mg (53%) of ketone amide b as a light yellow gum.
  • Example 60
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00181
  • Following the procedure for preparing triflate from example 56, 5-hydroxyquinoline a (3.42 g, 23.6 mmol) afforded 6.0 g (92%) of triflate b as light yellow liquid.
  • Example 61
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00182
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 57, triflate a (6.0 g, 21.7 mmol) afforded 3.58 g (97%) of ketone b as a brown oil.
  • Example 62
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00183
  • Following the procedure for preparing triflate from example 56, 2-(trifluoromethyl)-4-hydroxyquinoline a (6.87 g, 32.3 mmol) afforded 9.31 g (84%) of triflate b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 63
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00184
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 57, triflate a (7.35 g, 21.3 mmol) afforded 1.79 g (35%) of ketone b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 64
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00185
  • Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 59, 2-phenyl-4-quinolinecarboxylic acid a (5.0 g, 20.1 mmol) afforded 3.29 g (56%) of amide b as an off white solid.
  • Example 65
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00186
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 49, amide a (3.29 g, 11.26 mmol) afforded 3.29 g (118%) of ketone b as a yellow solid. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Sato et al. (JP 2002371078), Wong et al (WO 9846572), Leardini et al. (J. Chem. Soc., Chem. Communications 1984, 20, 1320-1), Kaneko et al. (Chem. & Pharm. Bull. 1982, 30(1), 74-85), Schwenk et al. (J. Org. Chem. 1946, 11, 798-802) and Shivers et al (J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1947, 69, 119-23).
  • Example 66
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00187
  • Following the procedure for preparing amide from example 59, 2-hydroxy-4-quinolinecarboxylic acid a (5.0 g, 26.4 mmol) afforded 1.88 g (30%) of amide b as a cream color solid.
  • Example 67
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00188
  • Following the procedure for preparing ketone from example 49, amide a (1.88 g, 8.1 mmol) afforded 993 mg (66%) of ketone b as a light yellow solid. Compound b may also be prepared according to the procedures described by Wetzel et al. (J. Med. Chem. 1973, 16(5), 528-32), Jones et al. (J. Chem. Soc. [Section C]: Organic 1967, 19, 1808-13) and Ochia et al. (Chem. & Pharm. Bull. 1963, 11, 137-8).
  • Example 68
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00189
  • Boc-ester a (900 mg, 2.0 mmol) was dissolved in THF (20 mL) and MeOH (1 mL) at ice water bath temperature. NaBH4 (300 mg, 8.0 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred for 1 h then another 1 h at RT. Reaction was quenched with the addition of few drops of water, then diluted with more water (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (2×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated in vacuo to afford 739 mg (90%) of alcohol b as a yellow foamy solid.
  • Example 69
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00190
  • To the mixture of amine a (159 mg, 0.46 mmol), Boc-cyclohexyl-Gly-OH b (129 mg, 0.50 mmol), and HATU (350 mg, 0.92 mmol) in MeCN (4 mL) was added DIPEA (162 μL, The resulting mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h. LCMS indicated incomplete reaction. An extra equivalence of HATU (175 mg, 0.46 mmol) and DIPEA (81 μL, 0.46 mmol) were added and stirred for another 1 h. Solvent was removed in vacuo, diluted with CH2Cl2 (10 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl (10 mL) and with water, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (0-5% MeOH/CH2Cl2) to afford 187 mg (74%) of product c as a brown solid.
  • Example 70
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00191
  • To the mixture of amine a (62 mg, 0.13 mmol), Boc-N-Me-Ala-OH b (27 mg, 0.13 mmol), and HATU (99 mg, 0.26 mmol) in MeCN (2 mL) was added DIPEA (46 μL, 0.26 mmol). The resulting mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h. Solvent was removed in vacuo, diluted with CH2Cl2 (10 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl (10 mL) and with water, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated to afford 69 mg (85%) of product c as a clear oil.
  • Example 71
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00192
  • A mixture of di-peptide a (100 mg, 0.29 mmol), thiazole amine b (113 mg, 0.32 mmol), HOAt (59 mg, 0.435 mmol), and DIC (67 μL, 0.435 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (3 mL) was stirred at RT for overnight. The mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2 (10 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl (10 mL) and 0.5 N NaOH (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column (10-90% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 175 mg (89%) of product c as a clear oil.
  • Example 72
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00193
  • Boc-amine a (175 mg, 0.26 mmol) was treated with (1:1) TFA/CH2Cl2 (8 mL), catalytic toluene at RT for 1 h. Solvent was removed in vacuo. The residue was purified by reverse-phase HPLC (C18, MeCN—H2O, 0.1% TFA) and lyophilized to afford 98 mg (49%, in 2 steps) of desired product b as a hygroscopic white solid.
  • Example 73
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00194
  • A mixture of the Boc-ester a (200 mg, 0.30 mmol), LiOH (200 mg, 0.30 mmol) in THF (2 mL), and water (25 μL) was stirred at RT for 1 h. MeOH (500 μL) was added and stirred at RT overnight. It was diluted with EtOAc (10 mL), washed with 0.5 N HCl (10 mL), dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo to afford 160 mg (82%) of Boc acid 187 as a white solid.
  • Example 74
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00195
  • A mixture of the Boc nitrile a (200 mg, 0.31 mmol), NaN3 (309 mg, 4.75 mmol), and NH4Cl (252 mg, 4.75 mmol) in DMF (3 mL) was heated at 100° C. for 3.5 d. It was cooled to RT, diluted with water, extracted with EtOAc (2×50 mL), washed with brine, dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 4 g column (10-90% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 37 mg of tetrazole # as a brown oil. More material was recovered by extracting the aqueous layer with CH2Cl2 to recover 65 mg of product. A combined 102 mg (49%) of tetrazole b was isolated.
  • Example 75
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00196
  • A mixture of the Boc ester a (135 mg, 0.20 mmol), KOH (14.5 mg, 0.26 mmol) in EtOH (4 mL) was stirred at RT for 2 h, then diluted with EtOAc (8 mL), acidified with 1 N HCl, separated, dried (MgSO4), concentrated in vacuo, and high vacuum dried. The crude product b was carried on without further purification.
  • Example 76
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00197
  • Following the general procedure of Yamamoto [Asao, N; Lee, S.; Yamamoto, Y. Tetrahedron Letters, 2003, 4265-4266.], MeLi (20 mL of 1.6M solution in ether, 30.2 mmol) was added to a 0° C. suspension of powdered CuI (2.90 g, 15.1 mmol) and ether (5 mL). The resulting grey solution was stirred vigorously for 10 min then concentrated under reduced pressure at 0° C. Dichloromethane (20 mL, precooled to 0° C.) was added, then the suspension was cooled to −78° C. and TMSCl (1.9 mL, 15.1 mmol) was added followed quickly by a solution of ester 192 [WO 01168603] (1.0 g, 5.0 mmol) and CH2Cl2 (50 mL), the mixture was stirred vigorously at −78° C. for 30 min, then at 0° C. for 2 h. The mixture was then poured into 200 mL of 1:1 saturated NH4Cl:NH4OH. The layers were separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×20 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×20 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 0-8% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 783 mg (72%) of ester 193 as a clear oil.
  • Example 77
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00198
  • A solution of ester a (780 mg), CH2Cl2 (5 mL), and TFA (2 mL) was maintained at rt overnight. The solvents were removed under reduced pressure to afford quantitative yield acid b as a colorless oil which was used without further purification.
  • Example 78
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00199
  • Following the general procedure of Evans [Evans, D. A.; Britton, T. C.; Ellman, J. A.; Dorow, R. L. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1990, 112, 4011-4030], pivaloyl chloride (3.2 mL, 26 mmol) was added to a −10° C. solution of acid a (3.72 g, 23.5 mmol), TEA (4.3 mL, 31 mmol) and THF (50 mL). The resulting white slurry was allowed to warm to −5° C. over 20 min with vigorous stirring. The mixture was then cooled to −78° C. and a solution of the lithium salt of (S)-4-benzyl-2-oxazolidinone (prepared from (S)-4-benzyl-2-oxazolidinone (7.5 g, 42.3 mmol), n-BuLi (26 mL of 1.6M solution in hexanes, 42.3 mmol) and THF (150 mL) at −78° C.) was added via cannula over 10 min. The mixture was maintained at −78° C. for 1 h, then quenched with saturated NH4Cl (200 mL) and the THF removed under reduced pressure. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column, 5-40% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 5.7 g (76%) of imide b as a clear oil.
  • Example 79
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00200
  • Following the general procedure of Evans [Evans, D. A.; Britton, T. C.; Ellman, J. A.; Dorow, R. L. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1990, 112, 4011-4030], a cold (−78° C.) solution of imide a (5.7 g, 18 mmol) and THF (64 mL) was added to a cold (−78° C.) solution of KHMDS (20 mmol) and THF (120 mL) over 10 min. The colorless solution was maintained at −78° C. for 30 min., then a cold (−78° C.) solution of TrsylN3 (6.9 g, 22.4 mmol) and THF (40 mL) was added via cannula over 5 min. Acetic acid (5.3 mL, 90 mmol) was added and the mixture was immediately brought to 30° C. and held there for 1 h. The reaction was quenched with brine (200 mL) and CH2Cl2 (200 mL). The phases were separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with saturated NaHCO3 (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 330 g column, 5-45% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 4.2 g (65%) of azo imide b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 80
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00201
  • A mixture of azido-imide a (4.7 g, 13 mmol) LiOH.H2O (660 mg, 15.6 mmol) THF (93 mL) and water (31 mL) was maintained at rt for 1 d. Further LiOH.H2O (200 mg) was added, and the mixture stirred for 2 h. Solid NaHCO3 (2.18 g) was added and the THF removed under reduced pressure. Following dilution with water (150 mL), the aqueous phase was washed with CH2Cl2 (3×50 mL) and the combined organic phases were extracted with saturated NaHCO3 (1×50 mL). The combined aqueous phases were acidified with con. HCl to pH<2 and extracted with EtOAc (4×50 mL). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to yield 1.38 g (53%) of acid b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 81
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00202
  • Isoquinoline carboxylic acid a (5.0 g, 28.9 mmol), N, O-dimethyl-hydroxylamine hydrochloride (3.1 g, 31.8 mmol) EDC (6.1 g, 32 mmol), DIPEA (5.7 mL, 32 mmol) and MeCN (50 mL) were mixed together and stirred at rt overnight. The MeCN was removed under reduced pressure and the residue partitioned between water (200 mL) and EtOAc (200 mL). The phases were separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc (2×50 mL). The combined organic phases were b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 82
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00203
  • Methyl magnesium chloride (12.3 mL of 3.0M THF) was added to a 0° C. solution of amide a (4.0 g, 18.5 mmol) and THF (40 mL). After 30 min at 0° C., the cooling bath was removed for 40 min. The reaction was poured into cold saturated NH4Cl (200 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with water, brine, dried (Na2SO4), and concentrated to yield 3.15 g (100%) of ketone b as a colorless oil.
  • Example 83
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00204
  • Following the general procedure of Barlin [Barlin, G. A.; Davies, L. P.; Ireland, S. J.; Ngu, M. M. L. Aust. J. Chem. 1989, 42, 1735-1748], Br2 (150 μL, 2.92 mmol) was added in one portion to a solution of ketone a (500 mg, 2.92 mmol) and 33% HBr/AcOH (10 mL). After 1 h, ether (20 mL) was added, and the ppt was collected on filter paper, washed with ether, and dried under vacuum to afford 910 mg (94%) of bromide b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 84
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00205
  • A mixture of 4-carboxy-2-hydroxyquinoline a (500 mg, 2.64 mmol) and POCl3 (5 mL) was heated at 100° C. for 1 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and the residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (10 mL), and cooled to 0° C. Morpholine (1.0 mL, 13.2 mmol) was added dropwise, and the mixture was allowed to come to rt. The mixture was then re-cooled to 0° C. and more morpholine (1.0 mL, 13.2 mmol) was added dropwise, and the mixture was allowed to come to rt overnight. The mixture was then diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 mL), and washed with saturated NH4Cl (3×20 mL). The combined aqueous phases were extracted with CH2Cl2 (1×20 mL), and the combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 5-75% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 570 mg (78%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 85
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00206
  • Diethyl zinc (2.3 mL of 1.1M solution in toluene, 2.5 mmol) was added to a mixture of amide a (500 mg, 1.8 mmol), NiCl2DPPP (100 mg, 0.18 mmol), and THF (5 mL) (caution was used due to exothermic reaction). The dark solution was then heated at 100° C. in a μW reactor for 15 min. The reaction was then quenched into saturated NH4Cl (50 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 0-75% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 350 mg (71%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 86
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00207
  • Diisopropyl zinc (3 ml of 10M solution in toluene, 2.5 mmol) was added to a mixture of chloride a (500 mg, 1.8 mmol), NiCl2DPPP (115 mg, 0.18 mmol), and THF (3 mL) The dark solution was then heated at 100° C. in a μW reactor for 15 min. The reaction was then quenched into saturated NH4Cl (50 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 0-15% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 383 mg (74%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 87
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00208
  • Methyl magnesium chloride (12.3 mL of 3.0M in THF, 37 mmol) was added to 0° C. solution of amide a (2.84 g, 10.51 mmol) and THF (20 mL). The solution was allowed to come to rt, then maintained at that temp. for 4 h. The reaction was quenched into cold saturated NH4Cl (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column, 0-30% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 1.88 g (86%) of ketone b as a colorless oil.
  • Example 88
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00209
  • Following the general procedure of Barlin [Barlin, G. A.; Davies, L. P.; Ireland, S. J.; Ngu, M. M. L. Aust. J. Chem. 1989, 42, 1735-1748], Br2 (640 μL, 2.92 mmol) was added in one portion to a solution of ketone a (2.27 g, 11.4 mmol) and 33% HBr/AcOH (40 mL). After 1 h, ether (50 mL) was added, and the ppt was collected on filter paper, washed with ether, and dried under vacuum to afford 3.88 g (94%) of bromide b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 89
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00210
  • Following the general procedure of Rieke [Zhu, L.; Wehmeyer, R. M.; Rieke, R. D. J. Org. Chem. 1991, 56, 1445-1453], propyl zinc bromide (4.0 mL of 0.5M solution in THF, 2.0 mmol) was added to a mixture of chloride a (500 mg, 1.81 mmol), Pd(PPh3)4 (100 mg, 0.09 mmol) and THF (3 mL). The resulting solution was heated at 70° C. in a μW reactor for 15 min. The reaction was then quenched into saturated NH4Cl (50 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 0-75% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 400 mg (77%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 90
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00211
  • Following the general procedure of Rieke [Zhu, L.; Wehmeyer, R. M.; Rieke, R. D. J. Org. Chem. 1991, 56, 1445-1453], cyclopentyl zinc bromide (4.0 mL of 0.5M solution in THF, 2.0 mmol) was added to a mixture of chloride a (500 mg, 1.81 mmol), Pd(PPh3)4 (100 mg, 0.09 mmol) and THF (3 mL). The resulting solution was heated at 70° C. in a μW reactor for 15 min. The reaction was then quenched into saturated NH4Cl (50 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 0-75% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 333 mg (59%) of amide b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 91
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00212
  • Methyl magnesium chloride (7.3 mL of 3.0M in THF, 22 mmol) was added to 0° C. solution of amide a (1.77 g, 6.2 mmol) and THF (15 mL). The solution was allowed to come to rt, then maintained at that temp. for 4 h. The reaction was quenched into cold saturated NH4Cl (100 mL), extracted with EtOAc (3×50 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column, 0-30% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 1.14 g (85%) of ketone b as a colorless oil.
  • Example 92
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00213
  • Following the general procedure of Angibaud [Angibaud, P; et. al, Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett. 2003, 13, 4365-4369], a mixture of chloride a (1.0 g, 5.0 mmol) NaN3 (1.6 g, 25 mmol) DMF (10 mL) and water (1.0 mL) was heated at heated at 120° C. in a μW reactor for 2 h. The reaction was then quenched into water (50 mL), and extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column, 0-50% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 300 mg (28%) of tetrazole b as a yellow solid.
  • Example 93
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00214
  • Trifluoromethane sulfonic anhydride (5.0 g, 17.7 mmol) was added drop wise to a mixture of 2-methyl-4-hydroxyquinoline a (2.56 g, 16.1 mmol) and pyridine (1.54 mL, 17.7 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (25 mL) at ice water bath temperature under N2. The mixture was allowed to warm to 10° C. It was diluted with CH2Cl2 (100 mL), washed with saturated NaHCO3 (3×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (0-30% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 2.57 g (54%) of triflate b as a dark oil.
  • Example 94
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00215
  • Following the general triflation procedure, 7-chloro-4-hydroxyquinoline a (10.0 g, 35.4 mmol) afforded 7.5 g (68%) of triflate b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 95
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00216
  • Following the general triflation procedure 6-fluoro-4-hydroxyquinoline a (5.0 g, 28.2 mmol) afforded 6.6 g (75%) of triflate b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 96
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00217
  • Following the general procedure of Legros [Tetrahedron 2001, 57, 2507-2514], a mixture of triflate a (7.5 g, 24.1 mmol), bis(dibenzylideneacetone)palladium(0) (690 mg, 1.2 mmol), 1,3-bis(diphenylphosphino)propane (546 mg, 1.33 mmol), and Et3N (10 mL, 72.3 mmol) in DMF (50 mL) were stirred at RT for 15 min under N2. n-Butyl vinyl ether (15 mL, 120 mmol) in DMF (15 mL) was added and the resulting mixture was stirred at 80° C. for 24 h. It was cooled to RT, 1 N HCl (150 mL) were added slowly, stirred at RT for 24 h. The mixture was neutralized with 1 N NaOH and extracted with ether (3×100 mL), dried (MgSO4), and concentrated. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column (5-30% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 1.62 g (32%) of ketone b as a white solid.
  • Example 97
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00218
  • Following the general procedure for preparing ketone from example 96, 6.56 g of triflate a afforded 3.14 g (73%) of ketone b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 98
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00219
  • Following the general procedure for preparing ketone from example 96, 2.57 g of triflate a afforded 820 mg (50%) of ketone b as a colorless solid.
  • Example 99
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00220
  • Methyl magnesium chloride (0.5 mL of 3.0M in THF, 1.5 mmol) was added to 0° C. solution of ester a (230 mg, 0.5 mmol) and THF (5 mL). The solution was maintained at 0° C. for 2 h. The reaction was quenched into cold saturated NH4Cl (50 mL), extracted with EtOAc (3×20 mL). The combined organic phases were washed with brine (1×50 mL), dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column, 0-50% ethyl acetate-hexanes to afford 135 mg (61%) of alcohol b as a colorless oil
  • Example 100
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00221
  • Bromine (122 μL, 2.4 mmol) was added to the solution of benzisoxazole ketone a (390 mg, 2.2 mmol) in AcOH (1.5 mL) and CH2Cl2 (6 mL). After 1 h at RT, LCMS indicated no reaction. Four drops of conc. HCl were added to the reaction mixture and stirred at RT overnight. It was quenched with 10% Na2S2O3, diluted with CH2Cl2 (100 mL) and water, separated, washed the organic layer with 5% NaHCO3, dried (MgSO4), and concentrated to afford 537 mg (95%) of bromo ketone b as an off white solid.
  • Example 101
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00222
  • A mixture of bromo ketone a (537 mg, 2.1 mmol), thioamide b (718 mg, 3.1 mmol), and pyridine (153 μL, 1.9 mol) in EtOH (15 mL) was heated at 70° C. for 1 h. It was concentrated in vacuo. The crude product was adsorbed on to Celite and purified by ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column (3-30% ethyl acetate-hexane) to afford 190 mg (23%) of thiazole c as a light yellow gum.
  • Example 102 Tetrahydropyranylglycine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00223
  • Tetrahydropyranylglycine was purchased from NovaBiochem, or synthesized according to the literature: Ghosh, A. K.; Thompson, W. J.; Holloway, M. K.; McKee, S. P.; Duong, T. T.; Lee, H. Y.; Munson, P. M.; Smith, A. M.; Wai, J. M; Darke, P. L.; Zugay, J. A.; Emini, E. A.; Schleife, W. A.; Huff, J. R.; Anderson, P. S. J. Med. Chem., 1993, 36, 2300-2310.
  • Example 103 Piperidinylglycine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00224
  • Piperidinylglycine was synthesized according to the procedures described by Shieh et al. (Tetrahedron: Asymmetry, 2001, 12, 2421-2425.
  • Example 104 4,4-difluorocyclohexylglycine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00225
  • 4,4-difluorocyclohexylglycine was made according to the procedures described in US 2003/0216325.
  • Example 105 Boc (S)-2-amino-2-(4-hydroxycyclohexyl)acetic Acid
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00226
  • Following the procedure described by Shieh et al. (Tetrahedron: Asymmetry, 2001, 12, 2421-2425), a solution of ketone a (8.4 g) and EtOAc (30 mL) was added to a solution of N-Cbz-phosphonoglycine methyl ester b, TMG (4.5 mL) and EtOAc (30 mL). The solution was maintained at rt for 48 h, then washed with 1N HCl (3×50 mL), brine (1×50 mL) dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was adsorbed onto Celite, and purified by chromatography, then further purified by re-crystallization from EtOAc/hexanes to afford 5.2 g of product c.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00227
  • Following the procedure described by Shieh, (Tetrahedron: Asymmetry, 2001, 12, 2421-2425), a solution of eneamide c (5.0 g), (S,S)-Me-BPE-Rh(I) (1.5 g, Strem Chemicals, Newburyport, Mass.), and MeOH (100 mL) was shaken vigorously under 70 psi of H2 for 48 h. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was taken up in EtOAc, and filtered through SiO2 with more EtOAc. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to afford 4.0 g of product d as a colorless solid.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00228
  • A mixture of Cbz-carbamate d, (4.0 g) Boc2O, (2.9 g), 20% Pd(OH)2.C (1.0 g) and MeOH (30 mL) was maintained under an atmosphere of H2 for 6 h. The mixture was filtered through Celite with MeOH. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure to afford 4.5 g of residue e, which was taken on directly.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00229
  • The residue e from above was dissolved in H2O (10 mL), AcOH (30 mL), THF (5 mL), and dichloroacetic acid (3 mL) and maintained at rt overnight. Water (5 mL) was added and the solution and maintained until hydrolysis was complete, as monitored by HPLC-MS. Solid Na2CO3 was added cautiously until gas evolution ceased, the mixture was diluted with aq NaHCO3, and extracted with 10% EtOAc/DCM. The combined organic phases were washed once with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by chromatography to afford 2.9 g of product f.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00230
  • A mixture of ketone f (1.5 g) MeOH (50 ml) was treated with NaBH4 (290 mg) at 0° C. for 20 min. The mixture was acidified to ˜pH1 with 10% aq citric acid and the MeOH was removed under reduced pressure. The residue was diluted with water and extracted with 20% EtOAc/DCM. The combined organic phases were washed once with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated. The residue was purified by chromatography to afford 1.17 g of product g and 0.23 g of product h.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00231
  • A mixture of ester g (1.17 g) LiOH.H2O (160 mg), THF (3 mL) and water (4.5 mL) was stirred vigorously at rt overnight. The mixture was diluted with brine and exhaustively extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic phases were washed once with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated to afford acid i (525 mg).
  • Example 106 N-Boc-N-cyclopropylmethyl-L-alanine
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00232
  • L-alanine methyl ester hydrochloride a (5 g, 35.8 mmol) and cyclopropanecarboxaldehyde b (2.67 ml, 35.8 mmol) were suspended in 50 ml THF w/1% AcOH. Addition of 5 ml of CH3OH made the cloudy solution turned to clear. NaCNBH4 (2.25 g, 35.8 mmol) was added and the reaction mixture stirred overnight. The reaction was quenched by addition of 1N aq. NaOH, extracted by EtOAc twice, organic layers were dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated to dryness. The crude material was purified by chromatography using 30% EtOAc/hexane (stained by ninhydrin) to obtain the compound c (1 g, 18%). The compound c (1 g, 6.37 mmol) and di-t-bocdicarbonate (2.1 g, 9.55 mmol) were diluted in THF (20 ml) and H2O (20 ml), NaHCO3 (1.3 g, 15.9 mmol) was added. The reaction mixture stirred overnight for completion. THF was removed under reduced pressure, and the aqueous layer was extracted by EtOAc 3 times. Combined organic layers were washed by 1N NaOH, sat, NH4Cl followed by brine, the concentrated to dryness. The Boc-protected compound d (1.39 g, 5.40 mmol) was stirred with LiOH.H2O (1.14 g, 27 mmol) in THF (20 ml) and H2O (20 ml) overnight at room temperature. THF was stripped off, and the aqueous layer was adjusted to pH=4 by adding 10% citric acid, then extracted by EtOAc 3 times. Combined organic layers were washed by brine and concentrated. The crude was purified by reverse phase C-18 column eluted by 0%-50% acetonitrile/H2O to give pure compound e as a white solid (794 mg).
  • Example 107
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00233
  • Phosphonate b (7.2 g, 21 mmol) was dissolved in THF (25 mL) at room temperature, and TMG (3.6 mL, 29 mmol, 1.3 equiv) was added dropwise. The mixture was stirred for 15 min at room temp. Commercially available ketone a (6.7 g, 43 mmol) was dissolved in THF (25 mL) and added dropwise to the mixture of phosphonate and base. The reaction was stirred for 24 h at room temperature and quenched by adding approx 200 mL of 1 N HCl. Organic products were quickly extracted into 80% ethyl acetate-hexanes (400 mL total). The combined organic phases were dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified twice by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column, 0-55% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 20 min, followed by 55% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 5 min, to afford 3.83 g (10.6 mmol, 50%) of the product amino ester c as a white solid.
  • Example 108
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00234
  • Ketal a (1.56 g, 4.73 mmol) was dissolved in 6 mL of THF. To this solution was added deionized water (15 mL), glacial acetic acid (6 mL), and dichloroacetic acid (1 mL). The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. Aqueous 1 N sodium hydroxide (approx. 100 mL) was added, and crude product was extracted into dichloromethane (approx. 200 mL). The organic product was adsorbed onto Celite by evaporation of the solvent, and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 80 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 20 min to afford 452 mg (1.58 mmol, 33%) of ketone b.
  • Example 109
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00235
  • Ester a (184 mg, 0.55 mmol) was dissolved in 2 mL of THF. Deionized water was added (1 mL), followed by lithium hydroxide monohydrate (42 mg, 1.0 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, then acidified using aqueous 1 N HCl and extracted into dichloromethane. Drying (Na2SO4), filtration and evaporation of the solvent yielded 175 mg (quantitative yield) of the carboxylic acid b.
  • Example 110
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00236
  • A small vial was charged with amine b (130 mg, 0.46 mmol), acid a (175 mg, 0.55 mmol) and EDC.HCl (135 mg, 0.70 mmol). The mixture was dissolved in dichloromethane (3 mL) and stirred overnight at room temperature. Celite was added to the reaction, and solvent was removed under reduced pressure. Crude product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-45% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 10 min followed by 45% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 5 min. The BOC-protected amine obtained from this coupling reaction was dissolved in dichloromethane (2 mL), deionized water (0.5 mL) and trifluoroacetic acid (1 mL) and allowed to stir for 3 h at room temperature. Organic solvents were removed under reduced pressure, the aqueous layer was made basic using a small amount of 1 N NaOH, and product was extracted into dichloromethane. Removal of organic solvent yielded 110 mg (0.25 mmol, 45% amine #) of the free amine #.
  • Example 111
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00237
  • Standard EDC coupling procedure was performed using amine b (110 mg, 0.25 mmol) L-BOC-N-methylalanine a (72 mg, 0.35 mmol) and EDC (67 mg, 0.35 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 5-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min followed by 55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 4 min. BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product c (54 mg, 66%) was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min.
  • Example 112
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00238
  • Following the general procedure of Burk [Burk, M. J.; Gross, M. F.; Martinez, J. P. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1995, 117, 9375-9376.], 5.0 g (13.8 mmol) of alkene a, 100 mL of dry methanol, and [(S,S)-Me-BPE-Rh(COD)]+OTf (1.5 g, 2.4 mmol) were mixed in a Parr shaker flask purged with nitrogen. Parr shaker was evacuated and subsequently charged to 70 psi of hydrogen gas for 32 hours. Methanol was removed under reduced pressure, and crude product was filtered through a small plug of silica gel using ethyl acetate. Evaporation of the solvent gave 4.0 g (11 mmol, 80%) of product b with >98% yield.
  • Example 113
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00239
  • Z-protected amino ester a (4.0 g, 11 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (30 mL). To this solution was added BOC-anhydride (2.9 g, 13.5 mmol), followed by 20% Pd(OH)2.C (1.0 g). All air was removed from the reaction flask by house vacuum, and the mixture was stirred vigorously for 5 min. The flask was then filled with hydrogen gas and allowed to stir vigorously at room temperature for 6 h. After evacuating the hydrogen atmosphere, the mixture was filtered through Celite using methanol, and crude product was obtained by evaporation of the solvent.
  • The product BOC-protected amine b was dissolved in 5 mL of THF. The following solvents were then added sequentially: deionized water (15 mL), glacial acetic acid (30 mL), and dichloroacetic acid (3 mL). The mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature, and the reaction was quenched by slowly adding solid sodium carbonate with vigorous stirring until the release of gas was no longer visible. Crude product was extracted into 10% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane. The product was adsorbed onto Celite by evaporation of the solvents, and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-36% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 20 min followed by flushing with 36% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 5 min to afford 2.86 g (10.0 mmol, 91%) of ketone b.
  • Example 114
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00240
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (46 mg, 0.15 mmol), carboxylic acid a (42 mg, 0.15 mmol syn-diastereomer) and EDC (33 mg, 0.17 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash stacker 2×4 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min, followed by 28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. The TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into dichloromethane.
  • Example 115
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00241
  • Coupling of the product primary amine a (20 mg, 0.044 mmol) to L-BOC-N-methylalanine b (12 mg, 0.059 mmol) was performed by adding EDC (10 mg 0.052 mmol) and dissolving in dichloromethane (1 mL). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash stacker 2×12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-70% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min followed by 70% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 5 min. BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of product anti-diastereomer c was 22 mg.
  • Example 116
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00242
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (110 mg, 0.38 mmol), carboxylic acid a, (105 mg, 0.38 mmol) and EDC (86 mg, 0.45 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash stacker 2×4 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min, followed by 28% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. The TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into dichloromethane.
  • Example 117
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00243
  • Coupling of the product primary amine b (170 mg, 0.35 mmol) to L-BOC-N-methylalanine a (81 mg, 0.40 mmol) was performed by adding EDC (77 mg 0.40 mmol) and dissolving in dichloromethane (2 mL). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash stacker 2×12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-70% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min followed by 70% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 5 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of anti-diastereomer product c was 106 mg.
  • Example 118
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00244
  • Ketone a (1.45 g, 5.3 mmol), was dissolved in dry diethyl ether (20 mL) and cooled to −78° C. Methyllithium (1.6 M in Et2O, 9.5 mL, 15 mmol) was added dropwise to the reaction mixture and stirred vigorously at the reduced temperature for 1 h. The reaction was quenched by pouring the cold mixture into saturated aqueous ammonium chloride and extracting the organics into dichloromethane. The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4), filtered, adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column, 0-50% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 25 min, followed by flushing 50% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min, and 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. This purification afforded 344 mg (1.1 mmol, 42%) of the syn-diastereomer c and 299 mg (0.99 mmol, 37%) of the anti-diastereomer b.
  • Example 119
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00245
  • Hydrolysis of the methyl ester a (300 mg, 0.99 mmol) was carried out by dissolving in THF (0.8 mL), adding deionized water (1.2 mL) and LiOH H2O (47 mg, 1.1 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 h, then reacidified using aqueous 1 N HCl and extracted into 90% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane. Brine was added to the aqueous acid layer to aid in the extraction. Drying (Na2SO4), filtration, and evaporation of the solvent yielded the carboxylic acid b (79 mg, 0.28 mmol).
  • Example 120
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00246
  • Hydrolysis of the methyl ester a (340 mg, 1.1 mmol) was carried out by dissolving in THF (0.9 mL), adding deionized water (1.4 mL) and LiOH.H2O (50 mg, 1.2 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 h, then reacidified using aqueous 1 N HCl and extracted into 90% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane. Brine was added to the aqueous acid layer to aid in the extraction. Drying (Na2SO4), filtration, and evaporation of the solvent yielded the carboxylic acid b (254 mg, 0.88 mmol), clean enough to use in the next step without purification.
  • Example 121
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00247
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (62 mg, 0.21 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (32 mg, 0.11 mmol) and EDC (21 mg, 0.11 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 22 min, followed by 67% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. The TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into ethyl acetate with 10% dichloromethane.
  • Example 122
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00248
  • Coupling of the primary amine b (47 mg, 0.1 mmol) to L-BOC-N-methylalanine a (65 mg, 0.30 mmol) was performed by adding EDC (61 mg, 0.32 mmol) and dissolving in dichloromethane (2 mL). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 5-65% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 25 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of anti-diastereomer product c was 22 mg (31% from proline amine starting material).
  • Example 123
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00249
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (82 mg, 0.27 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (95 mg, 0.33 mmol) and EDC (65 mg, 0.34 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 22 min, followed by 67% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. The TFA salt was treated with base (aqueous 1 N NaOH) and extracted into ethyl acetate with 10% dichloromethane.
  • Example 124
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00250
  • Coupling of the product primary amine b (70 mg, 0.15 mmol) to L-BOC-N-methylalanine a (37 mg, 0.18 mmol) was accomplished by adding EDC (36 mg 0.19 mmol) and dissolving in dichloromethane (2 mL). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 1-51% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min followed by 51% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Final product b was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of product b was 49 mg.
  • Example 125
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00251
  • Sulfide a (810 mg, 2.5 mmol), synthesized according to the general procedure of Shieh [Shieh, W-C.; Xue, S.; Reel, N.; Wu, R.; Fitt, J.; Repic, O. Tetrahedron: Asymmetry, 2001, 12, 2421-2425], was dissolved in methanol (25 mL). Oxone (4.5 g) was dissolved in deionized water (25 mL). The methanol solution of substrate was cooled to −10° C., and the aqueous solution of Oxone was added to the reaction slowly. The reaction was kept on ice and gradually allowed to warm to room temperature while stirring overnight. Deionized water was used to dilute the reaction to approx 150 mL, which was poured into 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes for extraction. The organic phase was dried (Na2SO4), adsorbed onto Celite and purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column, 5-90% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 30 min to afford 804 mg (2.27 mmol, 91%) of the product sulfone b.
  • Example 126
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00252
  • Following the general procedure of Burk [Burk, M. J.; Gross, M. F.; Martinez, J. P. J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1995, 117, 9375-9376.], alkene a (774 mg 2.19 mmol), dry methanol (40 mL), and [(S,S)-Me-BPE-Rh(COD)]+OTf (500 mg, 0.8 mmol) were mixed in a Parr shaker flask purged with nitrogen. Parr shaker was evacuated and subsequently charged to 60 psi of hydrogen gas and shaken vigorously overnight. Methanol was removed under reduced pressure, and crude product was filtered through a small plug of silica gel using ethyl acetate. Evaporation of the solvent yielded 730 mg (2.0 mmol, 94%) of product b with >98% yield.
  • Example 127
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00253
  • Z-protected amino ester a (804 mg, 2.27 mmol) was dissolved in methanol (16 mL). To this solution was added BOC-anhydride (1.5 g, 6.8 mmol), followed by 20% Pd(OH)2.C (250 mg). All air was removed from the reaction flask by house vacuum, and the mixture was stirred vigorously for 5 min. The flask was then filled with hydrogen gas and allowed to stir vigorously at room temperature for 6 h. After evacuating the hydrogen atmosphere, the mixture was filtered through Celite using methanol, and crude product b was obtained by evaporation of the solvent (508 mg, 1.56 mmol, 70% yield).
  • Example 128
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00254
  • Ester a (508 mg, 1.56 mmol) was dissolved in 8 mL of THF. Deionized water (4 mL) was added, followed by LiOH.H2O (120 mg, 2.8 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, acidified using aqueous 1 N HCl and extracted into ethyl acetate. Drying (Na2SO4), filtration and evaporation of the solvent yielded 372 mg (1.21 mmol, 78% yield) of the carboxylic acid b, clean enough to use in the next step without purification.
  • Example 129
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00255
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (100 mg, 0.2 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (58 mg, 0.29 mmol) and EDC (56 mg, 0.29 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-65% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 132 mg.
  • Example 130
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00256
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (130 mg, 0.3 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (60 mg, 0.28 mmol) and EDC (60 mg, 0.3 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-65% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 78 mg.
  • Example 131
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00257
  • Following the general procedure of Grigg [Blaney, P.; Grigg, R.; Rankovic, Z.; Thornton-Pett, M.; Xu, J. Tetrahedron, 2002, 58, 1719-1737] a roundbottom flask was charged with sodium hydride (480 mg 60% dispersion in oil, 12.0 mmol, 4.0 equiv) and purged with nitrogen for 15 min. THF (6.0 mL) was added to the flask, and the suspension was cooled to 0° C. using an ice water bath. A separate flask was charged with BOC-glycine a (525 mg, 3.0 mmol), dry THF (6.0 mL) and ethyl iodide (1.0 mL, 12 mmol, 4 equiv). This mixture was added dropwise to the NaH suspension in THF, with vigorous stirring at 0° C. After 1 h of stirring, the reaction was warmed to room temperature and allowed to stir overnight. The reaction was again cooled to 0° C., and methanol (4 mL) was added very slowly to quench the excess hydride. Deionized water was added to dilute the mixture, and methanol was removed under reduced pressure. Impurities were extracted into 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes, the aqueous layer was then acidified by adding solid citric acid until the pH reached 2-3. The product was extracted into 90% ethyl acetate-hexanes. This organic layer was dried (Na2SO4) and filtered. Removal of the solvents under reduced pressure afforded a quantitative yield of the product b.
  • Example 132
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00258
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (70 mg, 0.16 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (49 mg, 0.24 mmol) and EDC (46 mg, 0.24 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 82 mg.
  • Example 133
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00259
  • The free primary amine b (35 mg, 0.056 mmol), anhydrous potassium carbonate (70 mg, 0.5 mmol) and formamidine hydrochloride a (30 mg, 0.37 mmol) were mixed together in a vial and dissolved in methanol (1.2 mL). The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 1.5 hr. Glacial acetic acid was added until gas release was no longer visible, and the mixture was filtered. Reverse-phase HPLC, using a C18 column and a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 25 min with 0.1% TFA, separated the desired product c, affording 8.2 mg (0.015 mmol, 27% yield) of the TFA salt after lyophilization.
  • Example 134
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00260
  • A mixture of unprotected amino acid a (775 mg, 7.24 mmol) and sodium carbonate (1.69 g, 16.0 mmol) was dissolved in a 1:1 solution of deionized water and THF (15 mL each). To this mixture was added BOC-anhydride b (1.73 g, 7.96 mmol). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, and THF was removed under reduced pressure. The mixture was then acidified to pH 2-3 with saturated aqueous citric acid, and product was extracted into 10% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane. The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford clean BOC-protected amino acid c (1.40 g, 6.7 mmol, 93%) to be used without further purification.
  • Example 135
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00261
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine b (64 mg, 0.14 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (41 mg, 0.2 mmol) and EDC (38 mg, 0.2 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 10 min, followed by a steady flow of 55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 70.2 mg.
  • Example 136
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00262
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine hydrochloride b (250 mg, 0.67 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (187 mg, 0.81 mmol), DIPEA (0.35 mL, 2.0 mmol) and EDC (157 mg, 0.81 mmol). Reaction was stirred at room temperature for 48 h. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-25% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 10 min, followed by a steady flow of 26% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using HCl in dioxane (4.0 M, 3.0 mL).
  • To the primary amine hydrochloride c (170 mg, 0.38 mmol) and L-BOC-N-methylalanine (91 mg, 0.45 mmol), was added dichloromethane (2 mL), DIPEA (0.20 mL, 1.1 mmol) and EDC (86 mg, 0.45 mmol), stirring at room temperature for 24 h. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0.5-52% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 13 min followed by 52% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-60% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of final product was 90 mg.
  • Example 137
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00263
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine hydrochloride # (250 mg, 0.67 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (187 mg, 0.81 mmol), DIPEA (0.350 mL, 2.0 mmol) and EDC (157 mg, 0.81 mmol). Reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3 h. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-25% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 10 min, followed by a steady flow of 26% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using HCl in dioxane (4.0 M, 3.0 mL).
  • To the primary amine hydrochloride (160 mg, 0.35 mmol) and L-BOC-N-methylalanine (91 mg, 0.45 mmol), was added dichloromethane (2 mL), DIPEA (0.200 mL, 1.1 mmol) and EDC (86 mg, 0.45 mmol), stirring at room temperature for 24 h. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0.5-52% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 13 min followed by 52% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-60% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of product c was 79 mg.
  • Example 138
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00264
  • EDC coupling was performed using amine hydrochloride b (230 mg, 0.61 mmol), the carboxylic acid a, (165 mg, 0.75 mmol), DIPEA (0.350 mL, 2.0 mmol) and EDC (157 mg, 0.81 mmol). Reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3 h, LC/MS indicated only half complete. More carboxylic acid (160 mg) and EDC (150 mg) was added to the reaction, and the mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-55% ethyl acetate-hexanes over 17 min, followed by a steady flow of 56% ethyl acetate-hexanes for 5 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Coupling of the product primary amine c (199 mg, 0.5 mmol) to L-BOC-N-methylalanine (140 mg, 0.7 mmol) was performed with EDC (135 mg, 0.7 mmol) and dichloromethane (3 mL). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min followed by 40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane for 3 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water. Final product was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of final product was 178 mg.
  • Example 139
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00265
  • Methyl ketone a (480 mg, 3.0 mmol), synthesized according to the general procedure of Miki [Miki, Y.; Nakamura, N.; Hachiken, H.; Takemura, S. J. Heterocyclic Chem., 1989, 26, 1739-1745], was suspended in 33% HBr in acetic acid (6 mL). Elemental bromine was added in six portions (6×0.025 mL, 0.15 mL total, 3.0 mmol) with vigorous stirring at room temperature. The reaction appeared to have a light color after 10 min of stirring, when diethyl ether was added (10 mL). Stirring at room temperature was continued for 30 min. The mixture was filtered through a frit, and the solids left behind were rinsed with 20 mL of ether, transferred to a vial, and dried under high vacuum. The solid afforded (840 mg) was a mixture of desired product b and the HBr salt of the starting material, used without further purification in the thiazole-forming step.
  • Example 140
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00266
  • Thioamide a (2.26 mg, 9.8 mmol) was added to the mixture of bromomethyl ketone b and methyl ketone (1.44 g) in a roundbottom flask. Ethanol (30 mL) was added, dissolving the thioamide and suspending the salts. Pyridine was then added dropwise (0.4 mL, 5.0 mmol) and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 5 min. The reaction flask was then heated to 70° C. in an oil bath, with vigorous stirring. After 10 min, the suspension of salts was no longer visible and the reaction was homogeneous. The reaction was allowed to cool to room temperature for 45 min, and Celite was added along with toluene (20 mL). Solvents were removed under reduced pressure. The crude product adsorbed onto Celite was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 120 g column, 0-30% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min, followed by a gradient of 30-70% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 5 min, to afford 518 mg (1.4 mmol, 47%) of the product thiazole. Removal of BOC from the proline amine was accomplished by dissolving the substrate in 2:1 DCM:TFA with few drops of water, following the standard procedure. Free base was obtained by treating the TFA salt with 1 N aqueous sodium hydroxide and extracting the amine into dichloromethane. Drying of the organic layer (Na2SO4), filtering and removing the solvent under reduced pressure afforded 356 mg (1.3 mmol, 93%) of free amine c.
  • Example 141
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00267
  • HOAt, DIC procedure was used to couple the above dipeptide to amine. Secondary amine b (65 mg, 0.25 mmol), carboxylic acid a, (97 mg, 0.28 mmol) HOAt (53 mg, 0.4 mmol) and DIC (50 mg, 0.4 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 0-65% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 15 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 5-50% acetonitrile-water over 18 min. Yield of product c was 98 mg.
  • Example 142
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00268
  • HOAt, DIC procedure was used to couple the above dipeptide to amine. Secondary amine b (50 mg, 0.2 mmol), carboxylic acid a, (72 mg, 0.21 mmol) HOAt (40 mg, 0.3 mmol) and DIC (38 mg, 0.3 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 12 g column with a solvent gradient of 10-85% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min. Standard BOC-deprotection was performed using 2:1 DCM:TFA+few drops of water. Final product c was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 3-40% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Yield of final product c was 25 mg.
  • Example 143
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00269
  • A mixture of unprotected amino acid a (1.1 g, 10 mmol) and sodium carbonate (850 mg, 10 mmol) was dissolved in a 1:1 solution of deionized water and THF (13 mL each). To this mixture was added FMOC-OSu b (6×550 mg, total 3.3 g, 9.8 mmol) over a period of 1 h. After each addition of FMOC-OSu was added 2-3 mL of 1 M aqueous sodium bicarbonate to keep the reaction mixture at basic pH. The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, and THF was removed under reduced pressure. The mixture was then diluted with deionized water, poured into ethyl acetate in a separatory funnel, and made acidic by the addition of 6 N HCl. After extracting into ethyl acetate, the organic layer was washed with deionized water, followed by brine. The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford clean FMOC-protected amino acid c (1.05 g, 3.19 mmol, 32%) to be used without further purification.
  • Example 144
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00270
  • Following the general procedure of Freidinger [Freidinger, R. M.; Hinkle, J. S.; Perlow, D. S.; Arison, B. H. J. Org. Chem., 1983, 48, 77-81], the FMOC-protected primary amine a (1.04 g, 3.17 mmol) was dissolved in toluene (60 mL). Paraformaldehyde (630 mg) was added, followed by a catalytic amount of p-toluenesulfonic acid (70 mg, 0.37 mmol). The mixture was vigorously stirred at reflux temperature for 45 min, collecting any generated water in a Dean Stark trap. The reaction mixture was then allowed to cool to room temperature, and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (2×30 mL). The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4), filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to afford 910 mg (2.7 mmol) of oxazolidinone b. The oxazolidinone (337 mg, 0.99 mmol) was dissolved in dichloromethane (20 mL). To this solution was added anhydrous aluminum trichloride (260 mg, 2.0 mmol), followed by triethylsilane (0.32 mL, 2.0 mmol). The reaction mixture was stirred for 5 h at room temperature and then quenched with 20 mL of 1 N aqueous HCl. The product carboxylic acid was extracted into 25% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane and washed with 1 N aqueous HCl (20 mL) followed by brine. The organic layer was dried (Na2SO4) and filtered. Celite was added, and the solvent was removed under reduced pressure. The crude product adsorbed onto Celite was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column, 1-55% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 25 min, to afford 272 mg (0.79 mmol, 25% yield from FMOC-primary amine) of the FMOC protected N-methyl amino acid c.
  • Example 145
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00271
  • Standard EDC coupling was performed using amine # (140 mg, 0.4 mmol), the crude carboxylic acid a, (176 mg, 0.4 mmol) and EDC (80 mg, 0.4 mmol). BOC-protected final product was purified by chromatography ISCO CombiFlash 40 g column with a solvent gradient of 1-40% ethyl acetate-dichloromethane over 20 min. The desired BOC-protected product was split into two portions for removing the FMOC group. The first portion (50 mg, 0.065 mmol) was dissolved in dichloromethane (1.0 mL), treated with piperidine (0.10 mL, 1.0 mmol), and allowed to stir at room temperature for 2 h. The second portion (100 mg, 0.13 mmol) was dissolved in 20% piperidine in DMF (1.0 mL) and allowed to stir at room temperature overnight. Both reactions were quenched by adding few drops of TFA. Final product was purified by reverse-phase HPLC C18 column with a solvent gradient of 3-40% acetonitrile-water over 20 min. Combined yield of final product c was 55 mg.
  • Example 146 IAP Inhibition Assays
  • In the following experiments was used a chimeric BIR domain referred to as MLXBIR3SG in which 11 of 110 residues correspond to those found in XIAP-BIR3, while the remainder correspond to ML-IAP-BIR. The chimeric protein MLXBIR3SG was shown to bind and inhibit caspase-9 significantly better than either of the native BIR domains, but bound Smac-based peptides and mature Smac with affinities similar to those of native ML-IAP-BIR. The improved caspase-9 inhibition of the chimeric BIR domain MLXBIR3SG has been correlated with increased inhibition of doxorubicin-induced apoptosis when transfected into MCF7 cells.
  • MLXBIR3SG Sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO.:1)
    MGSSHHHHHHSSGLVPRGSHMLETEEEEEEGAGATLSRGPAFPGMGSEEL
    RLASFYDWPLTAEVPPELLAAAGFFHTGHQDKVRCFFCYGGLQSWKRGDD
    PWTEHAKWFPGCQFLLRSKGQEYINNIHLTHSL
  • TR-FRET Peptide Binding Assay
  • Time-Resolved Fluorescence Resonance Energy Transfer competition experiments were performed on the Wallac Victor2 Multilabeled Counter Reader (Perkin Elmer Life and Analytical Sciences, Inc.) according to the procedures of Kolb et al (Journal of Biomolecular Screening, 1996, 1(4):203). A reagent cocktail containing 300 nM his-tagged MLXBIR3SG; 200 nM biotinylated SMAC peptide (AVPI); 5 μg/mL anti-his allophycocyanin (XL665) (CISBio International); and 200 ng/mL streptavidin-europium (Perkin Elmer) was prepared in reagent buffer (50 mM Tris [pH 7.2], 120 mM NaCl, 0.1% bovine globulins, 5 mM DTT and 0.05% octylglucoside). (Alternatively, this cocktail can be made using europium-labeled anti-His (Perkin Elmer) and streptavidin-allophycocyanin (Perkin Elmer) at concentrations of 6.5 nM and 25 nM, respectively). The reagent cocktail was incubated at room temperature for 30 minutes. After incubation, the cocktail was added to 1:3 serial dilutions of an antagonist compound (starting concentration of 50 μM) in 384-well black FIA plates (Greiner Bio-One, Inc.). After a 90 minute incubation at room temperature, the fluorescence was read with filters for the excitation of europium (340 nm) and for the emission wavelengths of europium (615 nm) and a allophycocyanin (665 nm). Antagonist data were calculated as a ratio of the emission signal of allophycocyanin at 665 nm to that of the emission of europium at 615 nm (these ratios were multiplied by a factor of 10,000 for ease of data manipulation). The resulting values were plotted as a function of antagonist concentration and fit to a 4-parameter equation using Kaleidograph software (Synergy Software, Reading, Pa.). Indications of antagonist potency were determined from the IC50 values. Compounds of the invention that were tested in this assay exhibited IC50 values of less than 200 μM indicating IAP inhibitory activity.
  • Fluorescence Polarization Peptide Binding Assay
  • Polarization experiments were performed on an Analyst HT 96-384 (Molecular Devices Corp.) according to the procedure of Keating, S. M., Marsters, J, Beresini, M., Ladner, C., Zioncheck, K., Clark, K., Arellano, F., and Bodary., S. (2000) in Proceedings of SPIE: In Vitro Diagnostic Instrumentation (Cohn, G. E., Ed.) pp 128-137, Bellingham, Wash. Samples for fluorescence polarization affinity measurements were prepared by addition of 1:2 serial dilutions starting at a final concentration of 5 μM of MLXBIR3SG in polarization buffer (50 mM Tris [pH 7.2], 120 mM NaCl, 1% bovine globulins 5 mM DTT and 0.05% octylglucoside) to 5-carboxyflourescein-conjugated AVPdi-Phe-NH2 (AVP-diPhe-FAM) at 5 nM final concentration.
  • Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00272
  • The reactions were read after an incubation time of 10 minutes at room temperature with standard cut-off filters for the fluorescein fluorophore (λex=485 nm.; λem=530 nm) in 96-well black HE96 plates (Molecular Devices Corp.). Fluorescence values were plotted as a function of the protein concentration, and the IC50s were obtained by fitting the data to a 4-parameter equation using Kaleidograph software (Synergy software, Reading, Pa.). Competition experiments were performed by addition of the MLXBIR3SG at 30 nM to wells containing 5 nM of the AVP-diPhe-FAM probe as well as 1:3 serial dilutions of antagonist compounds starting at a concentration of 300 μM in the polarization buffer. Samples were read after a 10-minute incubation. Fluorescence polarization values were plotted as a function of the antagonist concentration, and the IC50 values were obtained by fitting the data to a 4-parameter equation using Kaleidograph software (Synergy software, Reading, Pa.). Inhibition constants (Ki) for the antagonists were determined from the IC50 values. Compounds of the invention that were tested in this assay exhibited a Ki or less than 100 μM.

Claims (21)

1. A compound of formula I:
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00273
wherein
A is a 5-member aromatic heterocycle incorporating 1 to 4 heteroatoms N, O or S and is optionally substituted with one or more R7 and R8 groups;
Q is H, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and an alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with one or more hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano, nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle;
X1 and X2 are each independently O or S;
Y is a bond, (CR7R7)n, O or S; wherein n is 1 or 2 and R7 is H, halogen, alkyl, aryl, aralkyl, amino, arylamino, alkylamino, aralkylamino, alkoxy, aryloxy or aralkyloxy;
R1 is H or R1 and R2 together form a 5-8 member ring;
R2 is alkyl, a carbocycle, carbocyclylalkyl, a heterocycle or heterocyclylalkyl each optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, oxo, thione, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl, alkoxy, alkylthio, sulfonyl, amino and nitro;
R3 is H or alkyl optionally substituted with halogen or hydroxyl; or R3 and R4 together form a 3-6 heterocycle;
R3′ is H, or R3 and R3′ together form a 3-6 carbocycle;
R4 and R4′ are independently H, hydroxyl, amino, alkyl, carbocycle, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy or heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl; wherein each alkyl, carbocycloalkyl, carbocycloalkyloxy, carbocycloalkyloxycarbonyl, heterocycle, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkyloxy and heterocycloalkyloxycarbonyl is optionally substituted with halogen, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkyl, alkoxy, amino, imino and nitro; or R4 and R4′ together form a heterocycle;
R5 is H or alkyl;
R6, and R6′ are each independently H, alkyl, aryl or aralkyl;
R7 in each instance is independently H, cyano, hydroxyl, mercapto, halogen, nitro, carboxyl, amidino, guanidino, alkyl, a carbocycle, a heterocycle or —U—V; wherein U is —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)— and V is alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; and wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and an alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo, carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle;
R8 is H, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of said alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—, S(O)2, —N(R8), or —C(O)—; and said alkyl, carbocycle and heterocycle is optionally substituted with hydroxyl, alkoxy, acyl, halogen, mercapto, oxo (═O), carboxyl, acyl, halo-substituted alkyl, amino, cyano nitro, amidino, guanidino an optionally substituted carbocycle or an optionally substituted heterocycle;
and salts and solvates thereof.
2. The compound of claim 1, wherein ring A has the general formula II or II′:
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00274
wherein Z1 is NR8, O or S; and Z2, Z3 and Z4 are each independently N or CR7;
wherein R8 is H, alkyl or acyl; and R7 is H, halogen, amino, hydroxyl, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl or aralkyl.
3. The compound of claim 1, wherein ring A and Q together are selected from the group consisting of IIa-IIz:
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00275
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00276
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00277
wherein R8 is H, alkyl or acyl; and R7 is H, halogen, amino, hydroxyl, carboxyl, alkyl, haloalkyl or aralkyl.
4. The compound of claim 1, wherein Q is a carbocycle or heterocycle optionally substituted with halogen, amino, oxo, alkyl, a carbocycle or a heterocycle; wherein one or more CH2 or CH groups of an alkyl is optionally replaced with —O—, —S—, —S(O)—S(O)2, —N(R8)—, —C(O)—, —C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(O)—, —SO2—NR8—, —NR8—SO2—, —NR8—C(O)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—NR8—, —NR8—C(NH)—, —C(O)—O— or —O—C(O)—; and wherein said alkyl, carbocycle or heterocycle is optionally substituted with halogen, amino, hydroxyl, mercapto, carboxyl, alkoxy, alkoxyalkoxy, hydroxyalkoxy, alkylthio, acyloxy, acyloxyalkoxy, alkylsulfonyl, alkylsulfonylalkyl, alkylsulfinyl, and alkylsulfinylalkyl.
5. The compound of claim 1, wherein Q is a carbocycle or heterocycle selected from the group consisting of IIIa-IIIs:
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00278
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00279
Figure US20090176822A1-20090709-C00280
wherein n is 1-4; T is O, S, NR8 or CR7R7; and W is O, NR8 or CR7R7.
6. The compound of claim 1, wherein R1 is H.
7. The compound of claim 1, wherein R2 is alkyl, cycloalkyl or a heterocycle.
8. The compound of claim 1, wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of t-butyl, isopropyl, cyclohexyl, tetrahydropyran-4-yl, N-methylsulfonylpiperidin-4-yl, tetrahydrothiopyran-4-yl, tetrahydrothiopyran-4-yl (in which the S is in oxidized form SO or SO2), cyclohexan-4-one, 4-hydroxycyclohexane, 4-hydroxy-4-methylcyclohexane, 1-methyl-tetrahydropyran-4-yl, 2-hydroxyprop-2-yl, but-2-yl, phenyl and 1-hydroxyeth-1-yl.
9. The compound of claim 1, wherein R3 is methyl.
10. The compound of claim 1, wherein R4 is H or methyl, and R4′ is H.
11. The compound of claim 1, wherein R5 is H or methyl.
12. The compound of claim 1, wherein R6 and R6′ are independently H or methyl.
13. The compound of claim 1, wherein X1 and X2 are independently O.
14. The compound of claim 2, wherein R1 is H; R2 is isopropyl, t-butyl, cyclohexyl or pyran; R3 is methyl; R4 is H or methyl, R4′ is H; R5 is H or methyl; and X1 and X2 are both O.
15. A method of inducing apoptosis in a cell comprising introducing into said cell a compound of claim 1.
16. A method of sensitizing a cell to an apoptotic signal comprising introducing into said cell a compound of claim 1.
17. The method of claim 16, wherein said apoptotic signal is induced by contacting said cell with a compound selected from the group consisting of cytarabine, fludarabine, 5-fluoro-2′-deoxyuiridine, gemcitabine, methotrexate, bleomycin, cisplatin, cyclophosphamide, adriamycin (doxorubicin), mitoxantrone, camptothecin, topotecan, colcemid, colchicine, paclitaxel, vinblastine, vincristine, tamoxifen, finasteride, taxotere and mitomycin C or radiation.
18. The method of claim 16, wherein said apoptotic signal is induced by contacting said cell with Apo2L/TRAIL.
19. A method for inhibiting the binding of an IAP protein to a caspase protein comprising contacting said IAP protein with a compound of claim 1.
20. A method for treating a disease or condition associated with the overexpression of an IAP in a mammal, comprising administering to said mammal an effective amount of a compound of claim 1.
21. A method for treating cancer, comprising administering to said mammal an effective amount of a compound of claim 1.
US12/105,109 2004-12-20 2008-04-17 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap Abandoned US20090176822A1 (en)

Priority Applications (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12/105,109 US20090176822A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2008-04-17 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap
US12/538,794 US8609845B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2009-08-10 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP
US14/088,110 US9040706B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2013-11-22 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US63820204P 2004-12-20 2004-12-20
US11/312,063 US20060167066A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2005-12-19 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP
US12/105,109 US20090176822A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2008-04-17 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/312,063 Continuation US20060167066A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2005-12-19 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/538,794 Continuation US8609845B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2009-08-10 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20090176822A1 true US20090176822A1 (en) 2009-07-09

Family

ID=36129810

Family Applications (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/312,063 Abandoned US20060167066A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2005-12-19 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP
US12/105,109 Abandoned US20090176822A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2008-04-17 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap
US12/538,794 Active US8609845B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2009-08-10 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP
US14/088,110 Active US9040706B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2013-11-22 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/312,063 Abandoned US20060167066A1 (en) 2004-12-20 2005-12-19 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP

Family Applications After (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/538,794 Active US8609845B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2009-08-10 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP
US14/088,110 Active US9040706B2 (en) 2004-12-20 2013-11-22 Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP

Country Status (19)

Country Link
US (4) US20060167066A1 (en)
EP (1) EP1836201B2 (en)
JP (2) JP5007235B2 (en)
KR (2) KR101278732B1 (en)
CN (1) CN101146803A (en)
AT (1) ATE477254T1 (en)
AU (1) AU2005319305B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2588921C (en)
DE (1) DE602005022936D1 (en)
DK (1) DK1836201T4 (en)
EA (1) EA019420B1 (en)
ES (1) ES2349110T5 (en)
HK (1) HK1109155A1 (en)
IL (1) IL183514A (en)
MX (1) MX2007007195A (en)
NO (1) NO339157B1 (en)
NZ (1) NZ589670A (en)
WO (1) WO2006069063A1 (en)
ZA (1) ZA200704910B (en)

Cited By (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20110150827A1 (en) * 2009-12-18 2011-06-23 Idenix Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 5,5-fused arylene or heteroarylene hepatitis c virus inhibitors

Families Citing this family (118)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7727713B2 (en) 2001-06-20 2010-06-01 Nuevolution A/S Templated molecules and methods for using such molecules
DK1487978T3 (en) 2002-03-15 2009-03-23 Nuevolution As Improved method for synthesis of template molecules
AU2003247266A1 (en) 2002-08-01 2004-02-23 Nuevolution A/S Multi-step synthesis of templated molecules
DK2348124T3 (en) 2002-10-30 2014-03-10 Nuevolution As Synthesis of a bifunctional complex
WO2004056994A2 (en) 2002-12-19 2004-07-08 Nuevolution A/S Quasirandom structure and function guided synthesis methods
US20070026397A1 (en) 2003-02-21 2007-02-01 Nuevolution A/S Method for producing second-generation library
WO2005026387A1 (en) 2003-09-18 2005-03-24 Nuevolution A/S A method for obtaining structural information concerning an encoded molecule and method for selecting compounds
PL2253614T3 (en) 2004-04-07 2013-03-29 Novartis Ag Inhibitors of IAP
WO2006020060A2 (en) 2004-07-15 2006-02-23 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Iap binding compounds
MX2007007195A (en) 2004-12-20 2007-10-08 Genentech Inc Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap.
BRPI0607988A2 (en) 2005-02-25 2009-10-27 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals compound, pharmaceutical composition, and method for inducing apoptosis in a cell
US7772177B2 (en) 2005-05-18 2010-08-10 Aegera Therapeutics, Inc. BIR domain binding compounds
JP2008545008A (en) * 2005-06-30 2008-12-11 プロシディオン・リミテッド GPCR agonist
US20100256046A1 (en) * 2009-04-03 2010-10-07 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Treatment of proliferative disorders
DE102005046907A1 (en) 2005-09-30 2007-04-12 Voith Patent Gmbh Method and device for producing a tissue web
BRPI0617751A2 (en) 2005-10-25 2011-08-02 Aegera Therapeutics Inc iap bir domain binding compounds
EP2341140B1 (en) 2005-12-01 2017-07-19 Nuevolution A/S Enzymatic encoding methods for efficient synthesis of large libraries
JP5155184B2 (en) 2005-12-19 2013-02-27 ジェネンテック, インコーポレイテッド Inhibitors of IAP
TWI543988B (en) 2006-03-16 2016-08-01 科學製藥股份有限公司 Iap bir domain binding compounds
JP5419685B2 (en) 2006-05-16 2014-02-19 ファーマサイエンス・インコーポレイテッド IAPBIR domain binding protein
WO2008014229A2 (en) * 2006-07-24 2008-01-31 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Dimeric iap inhibitors
US20100056495A1 (en) * 2006-07-24 2010-03-04 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Dimeric iap inhibitors
US8143426B2 (en) 2006-07-24 2012-03-27 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation IAP inhibitors
WO2008014263A2 (en) 2006-07-24 2008-01-31 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Dimeric iap antagonists
US20100113326A1 (en) * 2006-07-24 2010-05-06 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Dimeric iap inhibitors
PE20110218A1 (en) 2006-08-02 2011-04-01 Novartis Ag DERIVATIVES OF 2-OXO-ETHYL-AMINO-PROPIONAMIDE-PYRROLIDIN-2-IL-SUBSTITUTED AS INHIBITORS OF THE BINDING OF THE PROTEIN Smac TO THE INHIBITOR OF THE PROTEIN OF APOPTOSIS
JP5190062B2 (en) * 2006-10-12 2013-04-24 ノバルティス アーゲー Pyrrolidine derivatives as IAP inhibitors
AU2007337104A1 (en) * 2006-12-19 2008-07-03 Genentech, Inc. Imidazopyridine inhibitors of IAP
EP2079309B1 (en) 2007-04-12 2015-11-11 Joyant Pharmaceuticals Inc Smac mimetic dimers and trimers useful as anti-cancer agents
BRPI0809867A2 (en) * 2007-04-30 2014-09-30 Genentech Inc COMPOUND, APOPTOSIS INDUCTION METHOD IN A CELL, CELL SENSITIZATION METHOD FOR AN APOPTOTIC SIGN, METHOD FOR INHIBITING THE CONNECTION OF AN IAP PROTEIN TO A CASPASE PROTEIN AND METHODS
JP2010528587A (en) * 2007-05-07 2010-08-26 テトラロジック ファーマシューティカルズ コーポレーション Method using expression of TNFα gene as biomarker of sensitivity to apoptosis inhibitor protein antagonist
JP5176452B2 (en) * 2007-09-27 2013-04-03 住友化学株式会社 Process for producing optically active tetrahydropyranylglycine compound
WO2009089502A1 (en) * 2008-01-11 2009-07-16 Genentech, Inc. Inhibitors of iap
EP2250160B1 (en) 2008-01-25 2015-11-11 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Thiophenes and their use as phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase (pi3k) inhibitors
TW201011006A (en) * 2008-06-16 2010-03-16 Nuevolution As IAP binding compounds
CA2730448A1 (en) 2008-08-02 2010-02-11 Genentech, Inc. Inhibitors of iap
WO2010021934A2 (en) * 2008-08-16 2010-02-25 Genentech, Inc. Azaindole inhibitors of iap
US9090601B2 (en) 2009-01-30 2015-07-28 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Thiazole derivatives
EP2391619A1 (en) 2009-01-30 2011-12-07 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Heteroaryls and their use as pi3k inhibitors
US8283372B2 (en) 2009-07-02 2012-10-09 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corp. 2-(1H-indol-3-ylmethyl)-pyrrolidine dimer as a SMAC mimetic
TW201109335A (en) 2009-08-04 2011-03-16 Takeda Pharmaceutical Heterocyclic compounds
CN105646471A (en) 2009-08-12 2016-06-08 诺华股份有限公司 Solid oral formulations and crystalline forms of inhibitor of apoptosis protein
US20120196793A1 (en) 2009-09-18 2012-08-02 Firestone Brant G Biomarkers for iap inhibitor compounds
US8551955B2 (en) 2009-10-28 2013-10-08 Joyant Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Dimeric Smac mimetics
BR112012020113A2 (en) 2010-02-12 2016-06-07 Pharmascience Inc iap bir domain binding compounds
LT2558577T (en) 2010-04-16 2019-03-12 Nuevolution A/S Bi-functional complexes and methods for making and using such complexes
US9062038B2 (en) 2010-08-11 2015-06-23 Millennium Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Heteroaryls and uses thereof
WO2012126881A1 (en) 2011-03-22 2012-09-27 Syngenta Participations Ag Insecticidal compounds
GB201106817D0 (en) 2011-04-21 2011-06-01 Astex Therapeutics Ltd New compound
CN102757426A (en) * 2011-04-28 2012-10-31 中国医学科学院医药生物技术研究所 Benzoisooxazolyl substituted thiazole compound, preparation method and application thereof
NO2755614T3 (en) 2012-01-03 2018-03-31
EP3608317A1 (en) 2012-01-12 2020-02-12 Yale University Compounds & methods for the enhanced degradation of targeted proteins & other polypeptides by an e3 ubiquitin ligase
CA2871995A1 (en) 2012-05-04 2013-11-07 Novartis Ag Biomarkers for iap inhibitor therapy
US9980973B2 (en) 2012-10-19 2018-05-29 Astex Therapeutics Limited Bicyclic heterocycle compounds and their uses in therapy
GB201218850D0 (en) 2012-10-19 2012-12-05 Astex Therapeutics Ltd Bicyclic heterocycle compounds and their uses in therapy
GB201218864D0 (en) 2012-10-19 2012-12-05 Astex Therapeutics Ltd Bicyclic heterocycle compounds and their uses in therapy
GB201218862D0 (en) 2012-10-19 2012-12-05 Astex Therapeutics Ltd Bicyclic heterocycle compounds and their uses in therapy
ES2828510T3 (en) * 2013-02-15 2021-05-26 Univ Nat Corp Tokyo Medical & Dental Therapeutic agent to treat a cancer in which NRF2 is stabilized
US9498532B2 (en) 2013-03-13 2016-11-22 Novartis Ag Antibody drug conjugates
EP3514178A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2019-07-24 Novartis AG Antibody drug conjugates
GB201311891D0 (en) 2013-07-03 2013-08-14 Glaxosmithkline Ip Dev Ltd Novel compound
GB201311888D0 (en) 2013-07-03 2013-08-14 Glaxosmithkline Ip Dev Ltd Novel compounds
AU2014369446C1 (en) 2013-12-20 2020-03-12 Astex Therapeutics Limited Bicyclic heterocycle compounds and their uses in therapy
US10300074B2 (en) 2014-06-04 2019-05-28 Sanford Burnham Prebys Medical Discovery Institute Use of inhibitor of apoptosis protein (IAP) antagonists in HIV therapy
US10786578B2 (en) 2014-08-05 2020-09-29 Novartis Ag CKIT antibody drug conjugates
US10071164B2 (en) 2014-08-11 2018-09-11 Yale University Estrogen-related receptor alpha based protac compounds and associated methods of use
PE20170903A1 (en) 2014-08-12 2017-07-12 Novartis Ag DRUG CONJUGATES WITH ANTI-CDH6 ANTIBODIES
US20170327469A1 (en) 2015-01-20 2017-11-16 Arvinas, Inc. Compounds and methods for the targeted degradation of androgen receptor
JP6817962B2 (en) 2015-01-20 2021-01-20 アルビナス・オペレーションズ・インコーポレイテッドArvinas Operations, Inc. Compounds and methods for targeted androgen receptor degradation
EP3302482A4 (en) 2015-06-05 2018-12-19 Arvinas, Inc. Tank-binding kinase-1 protacs and associated methods of use
EP3310813A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2018-04-25 Novartis AG Antibody drug conjugates
WO2017030814A1 (en) 2015-08-19 2017-02-23 Arvinas, Inc. Compounds and methods for the targeted degradation of bromodomain-containing proteins
MA44334A (en) 2015-10-29 2018-09-05 Novartis Ag ANTIBODY CONJUGATES INCLUDING A TOLL-TYPE RECEPTOR AGONIST
IL304982A (en) 2016-11-01 2023-10-01 Arvinas Operations Inc Tau-protein targeting protacs and associated methods of use
LT3689868T (en) 2016-12-01 2023-12-27 Arvinas Operations, Inc. Tetrahydronaphthalene and tetrahydroisoquinoline derivatives as estrogen receptor degraders
WO2018119441A1 (en) 2016-12-23 2018-06-28 Arvinas, Inc. Egfr proteolysis targeting chimeric molecules and associated methods of use
US11173211B2 (en) 2016-12-23 2021-11-16 Arvinas Operations, Inc. Compounds and methods for the targeted degradation of rapidly accelerated Fibrosarcoma polypeptides
WO2018118598A1 (en) 2016-12-23 2018-06-28 Arvinas, Inc. Compounds and methods for the targeted degradation of fetal liver kinase polypeptides
CN117510491A (en) 2016-12-23 2024-02-06 阿尔维纳斯运营股份有限公司 Compounds and methods for rapid accelerated targeted degradation of fibrosarcoma polypeptides
US11191741B2 (en) 2016-12-24 2021-12-07 Arvinas Operations, Inc. Compounds and methods for the targeted degradation of enhancer of zeste homolog 2 polypeptide
WO2018140809A1 (en) 2017-01-26 2018-08-02 Arvinas, Inc. Modulators of estrogen receptor proteolysis and associated methods of use
JOP20190187A1 (en) 2017-02-03 2019-08-01 Novartis Ag Anti-ccr7 antibody drug conjugates
WO2018163051A1 (en) 2017-03-06 2018-09-13 Novartis Ag Methods of treatment of cancer with reduced ubb expression
WO2018185618A1 (en) 2017-04-03 2018-10-11 Novartis Ag Anti-cdh6 antibody drug conjugates and anti-gitr antibody combinations and methods of treatment
AR111651A1 (en) 2017-04-28 2019-08-07 Novartis Ag CONJUGATES OF ANTIBODIES THAT INCLUDE TOLL TYPE RECEIVER AGONISTS AND COMBINATION THERAPIES
WO2018215938A1 (en) 2017-05-24 2018-11-29 Novartis Ag Antibody-cytokine engrafted proteins and methods of use
CN110662762A (en) 2017-05-24 2020-01-07 诺华股份有限公司 Antibody cytokine transplantation proteins and methods for treating cancer
WO2018215937A1 (en) 2017-05-24 2018-11-29 Novartis Ag Interleukin-7 antibody cytokine engrafted proteins and methods of use in the treatment of cancer
AU2018308116A1 (en) * 2017-07-25 2020-02-13 Hepagene Therapeutics (HK) Limited Dimeric peptide inhibitors of apoptosis proteins
EP3712162B1 (en) 2017-11-13 2022-08-24 Chia Tai Tianqing Pharmaceutical Group Co., Ltd. Smac mimetics used as iap inhibitors and use thereof
WO2019099926A1 (en) 2017-11-17 2019-05-23 Arvinas, Inc. Compounds and methods for the targeted degradation of interleukin-1 receptor-associated kinase 4 polypeptides
TWI812673B (en) 2018-02-12 2023-08-21 美商富曼西公司 Naphthalene isoxazoline compounds for controlling invertebrate pests
BR112020020307A2 (en) 2018-04-04 2021-01-12 Arvinas Operations, Inc. PROTEOLYSIS MODULATORS AND ASSOCIATED METHODS OF USE
AR116109A1 (en) 2018-07-10 2021-03-31 Novartis Ag DERIVATIVES OF 3- (5-AMINO-1-OXOISOINDOLIN-2-IL) PIPERIDINE-2,6-DIONA AND USES OF THE SAME
WO2020012334A1 (en) 2018-07-10 2020-01-16 Novartis Ag 3-(5-hydroxy-1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and their use in the treatment of ikaros family zinc finger 2 (ikzf2)-dependent diseases
WO2020023851A1 (en) 2018-07-26 2020-01-30 Yale University Bifunctional substitued pyrimidines as modulators of fak proteolyse
JP7297053B2 (en) 2018-08-20 2023-06-23 アルビナス・オペレーションズ・インコーポレイテッド Alpha-Synuclein Protein-Targeted Proteolysis Targeting Chimeric (PROTAC) Compounds with E3 Ubiquitin Ligase Binding Activity to Treat Neurodegenerative Diseases
CN113164775A (en) 2018-09-07 2021-07-23 阿尔维纳斯运营股份有限公司 Polycyclic compounds and methods for rapid accelerated targeted degradation of fibrosarcoma polypeptides
EP3873532A1 (en) 2018-10-31 2021-09-08 Novartis AG Dc-sign antibody drug conjugates
EP3897637A1 (en) 2018-12-20 2021-10-27 Novartis AG Dosing regimen and pharmaceutical combination comprising 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives
BR112021011900A2 (en) 2018-12-21 2021-09-08 Novartis Ag ANTIBODIES TO PMEL17 AND CONJUGATES THEREOF
WO2020165833A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Novartis Ag 3-(1-oxo-5-(piperidin-4-yl)isoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
CA3123519A1 (en) 2019-02-15 2020-08-20 Novartis Ag Substituted 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
JP7413346B2 (en) 2019-03-06 2024-01-15 第一三共株式会社 Pyrrolopyrazole derivative
MX2021013729A (en) * 2019-05-10 2021-12-10 Chia Tai Tianqing Pharmaceutical Group Co Ltd Crystallization of smac mimic used as iap inhibitor and preparation method thereof.
EP3999182A1 (en) 2019-07-17 2022-05-25 Arvinas Operations, Inc. Tau-protein targeting compounds and associated methods of use
WO2021023698A1 (en) 2019-08-02 2021-02-11 Lanthiopep B.V Angiotensin type 2 (at2) receptor agonists for use in the treatment of cancer
JP2023507190A (en) 2019-12-20 2023-02-21 ノバルティス アーゲー Use of anti-TGFβ antibodies and checkpoint inhibitors to treat proliferative diseases
WO2021220178A1 (en) 2020-04-29 2021-11-04 Cominnex Zrt. Iap antagonists and their therapeutic applications
US20230181756A1 (en) 2020-04-30 2023-06-15 Novartis Ag Ccr7 antibody drug conjugates for treating cancer
AU2021288224A1 (en) 2020-06-11 2023-01-05 Novartis Ag ZBTB32 inhibitors and uses thereof
AU2021297099A1 (en) 2020-06-23 2023-01-05 Novartis Ag Dosing regimen comprising 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives
EP4188549A1 (en) 2020-08-03 2023-06-07 Novartis AG Heteroaryl substituted 3-(1-oxoisoindolin-2-yl)piperidine-2,6-dione derivatives and uses thereof
TW202304979A (en) 2021-04-07 2023-02-01 瑞士商諾華公司 USES OF ANTI-TGFβ ANTIBODIES AND OTHER THERAPEUTIC AGENTS FOR THE TREATMENT OF PROLIFERATIVE DISEASES
WO2022221720A1 (en) 2021-04-16 2022-10-20 Novartis Ag Antibody drug conjugates and methods for making thereof
AR125874A1 (en) 2021-05-18 2023-08-23 Novartis Ag COMBINATION THERAPIES
WO2023214325A1 (en) 2022-05-05 2023-11-09 Novartis Ag Pyrazolopyrimidine derivatives and uses thereof as tet2 inhibitors
WO2024023666A1 (en) 2022-07-26 2024-02-01 Novartis Ag Crystalline forms of an akr1c3 dependent kars inhibitor

Citations (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4278793A (en) * 1977-04-02 1981-07-14 Hoechst Aktiengesellschaft Cephem derivative
US4720484A (en) * 1985-01-07 1988-01-19 Adir S.A.R.L. Peptide compounds having a nitrogenous polycyclic structure
US5411942A (en) * 1989-12-07 1995-05-02 Carlbiotech Ltd. A/S Peptide derivative, pharmaceutical preparation containing it and method for treatment of glaucoma
US5559209A (en) * 1993-02-18 1996-09-24 The General Hospital Corporation Regulator regions of G proteins
US6472172B1 (en) * 1998-07-31 2002-10-29 Schering Aktiengesellschaft DNA encoding a novel human inhibitor-of-apoptosis protein
US20020177557A1 (en) * 2000-09-29 2002-11-28 Yigong Shi Compositions and method for regulating apoptosis
US6608026B1 (en) * 2000-08-23 2003-08-19 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Apoptotic compounds
US20030157522A1 (en) * 2001-11-09 2003-08-21 Alain Boudreault Methods and reagents for peptide-BIR interaction screens
US20040171554A1 (en) * 2003-02-07 2004-09-02 Genentech, Inc. Compositions and methods for enhancing apoptosis
US20050214802A1 (en) * 2003-11-13 2005-09-29 Genentech, Inc. Compositions and methods for the screening pro-apoptotic compounds
US20050234042A1 (en) * 2004-04-07 2005-10-20 Palermo Mark G Organic compounds
US20060052311A1 (en) * 2002-07-02 2006-03-09 Sharma Sushil K Peptide inhibitors of smac protein binding to inhibitor of apoptosis proteins (IAP)

Family Cites Families (46)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
SE430062B (en) 1977-03-04 1983-10-17 Pharmacia Fine Chemicals Ab COUPLING OR TIOLATION REAGENTS
EP0217634B1 (en) 1985-09-26 1992-06-10 Beckman Research Institute of the City of Hope Sequencing of peptides
US4935494A (en) 1988-11-15 1990-06-19 City Of Hope C-terminal peptide and protein sequencing
CA2012306A1 (en) 1989-03-28 1990-09-28 Werner Neidhart Amino acid derivatives
WO1992001938A1 (en) 1990-07-20 1992-02-06 City Of Hope Derivatization of c-terminal proline
DE122004000036I1 (en) 1992-11-13 2005-07-07 Biogen Idec Inc Therapeutic use of chimeric and labeled antibodies to human B lymphocyte limited differentiation antigen for the treatment of B-cell lymphoma.
HUP9900964A3 (en) 1995-10-30 2001-02-28 Smithkline Beecham Corp Protease inhibitors and pharmaceutical compositions containing these compounds
WO1998046597A1 (en) 1997-04-14 1998-10-22 Emory University Serine protease inhibitors
US6335155B1 (en) 1998-06-26 2002-01-01 Sunesis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods for rapidly identifying small organic molecule ligands for binding to biological target molecules
WO2000039585A1 (en) 1998-12-28 2000-07-06 Sunesis Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Identifying small organic molecule ligands for binding
CA2420534A1 (en) 2000-08-24 2002-02-28 Thomas Jefferson University An iap binding peptide or polypeptide and methods of using the same
WO2002026775A2 (en) 2000-09-29 2002-04-04 Trustees Of Princeton University Compositions and methods for regulating apoptosis
WO2002030959A2 (en) 2000-10-13 2002-04-18 Abbott Laboratories Peptides derived from smac (diablo) and methods of use therefor
WO2003010184A2 (en) 2001-02-08 2003-02-06 Thomas Jefferson University A conserved xiap-interaction motif in caspase-9 and smac/diablo for mediating apoptosis
MXPA03008089A (en) 2001-04-05 2004-01-22 Torrent Pharmaceuticals Ltd Heterocyclic compounds for aging-related and diabetic vascular complications.
JP2004531731A (en) 2001-05-31 2004-10-14 ザ トラスティーズ オブ プリンストン ユニバーシテイ Assays for identifying IAP binding peptides and compounds that bind to IAP
WO2003086470A2 (en) 2002-04-17 2003-10-23 Deutsches Krebsforschungszentrum Smac-peptides as therapeutics against cancer and autoimmune diseases
ES2318167T3 (en) * 2002-07-15 2009-05-01 The Trustees Of Princeton University IAP UNION COMPOUNDS.
WO2004017991A1 (en) 2002-08-13 2004-03-04 Cell Center Cologne Gmbh Use of iap for the diagnosis and of iap-inhibitors for the treatment of hodgkin’s lymphomas
WO2004072641A1 (en) 2003-02-07 2004-08-26 Genentech, Inc. Compositions and methods for enhancing apoptosis
IL156263A0 (en) 2003-06-02 2004-01-04 Hadasit Med Res Service Livin-derived peptides, compositions and uses thereof
JP2007523061A (en) * 2004-01-16 2007-08-16 ザ リージェンツ オブ ザ ユニバーシティ オブ ミシガン SMAC peptide mimetics and uses thereof
AU2005206929B2 (en) 2004-01-16 2008-01-24 The Regents Of The University Of Michigan Conformationally constrained Smac mimetics and the uses thereof
WO2005084317A2 (en) 2004-03-01 2005-09-15 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Dimeric small molecule potentiators of apoptosis
CA2558615C (en) 2004-03-23 2013-10-29 Genentech, Inc. Azabicyclo-octane inhibitors of iap
KR100926203B1 (en) 2004-07-02 2009-11-09 제넨테크, 인크. Inhibitors of iap
EP1773348A4 (en) 2004-07-12 2009-05-20 Idun Pharmaceuticals Inc Tetrapeptide analogs
WO2006020060A2 (en) 2004-07-15 2006-02-23 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Iap binding compounds
MX2007007195A (en) 2004-12-20 2007-10-08 Genentech Inc Pyrrolidine inhibitors of iap.
BRPI0607988A2 (en) 2005-02-25 2009-10-27 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals compound, pharmaceutical composition, and method for inducing apoptosis in a cell
US7772177B2 (en) 2005-05-18 2010-08-10 Aegera Therapeutics, Inc. BIR domain binding compounds
BRPI0617751A2 (en) 2005-10-25 2011-08-02 Aegera Therapeutics Inc iap bir domain binding compounds
JP5155184B2 (en) 2005-12-19 2013-02-27 ジェネンテック, インコーポレイテッド Inhibitors of IAP
US7205737B1 (en) 2006-01-04 2007-04-17 Robert Bosch Gmbh Systems and methods of monitoring a motor load
TWI543988B (en) 2006-03-16 2016-08-01 科學製藥股份有限公司 Iap bir domain binding compounds
JP2009530424A (en) 2006-03-21 2009-08-27 ジョイアント ファーマスーティカルズ、インク. Small molecule apoptosis promoter
US8492511B2 (en) 2006-04-07 2013-07-23 Piotrek Co., Ltd. Process for the preparation of crosslinked nitroxide polymers
WO2008014238A2 (en) 2006-07-24 2008-01-31 Tetralogic Pharmaceuticals Corporation Dimeric iap inhibitors
PE20110218A1 (en) 2006-08-02 2011-04-01 Novartis Ag DERIVATIVES OF 2-OXO-ETHYL-AMINO-PROPIONAMIDE-PYRROLIDIN-2-IL-SUBSTITUTED AS INHIBITORS OF THE BINDING OF THE PROTEIN Smac TO THE INHIBITOR OF THE PROTEIN OF APOPTOSIS
US8329159B2 (en) 2006-08-11 2012-12-11 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Hepatitis C virus inhibitors
JP5190062B2 (en) 2006-10-12 2013-04-24 ノバルティス アーゲー Pyrrolidine derivatives as IAP inhibitors
AU2007337104A1 (en) 2006-12-19 2008-07-03 Genentech, Inc. Imidazopyridine inhibitors of IAP
BRPI0809867A2 (en) 2007-04-30 2014-09-30 Genentech Inc COMPOUND, APOPTOSIS INDUCTION METHOD IN A CELL, CELL SENSITIZATION METHOD FOR AN APOPTOTIC SIGN, METHOD FOR INHIBITING THE CONNECTION OF AN IAP PROTEIN TO A CASPASE PROTEIN AND METHODS
WO2009089502A1 (en) 2008-01-11 2009-07-16 Genentech, Inc. Inhibitors of iap
CA2730448A1 (en) 2008-08-02 2010-02-11 Genentech, Inc. Inhibitors of iap
WO2010021934A2 (en) 2008-08-16 2010-02-25 Genentech, Inc. Azaindole inhibitors of iap

Patent Citations (14)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4278793A (en) * 1977-04-02 1981-07-14 Hoechst Aktiengesellschaft Cephem derivative
US4720484A (en) * 1985-01-07 1988-01-19 Adir S.A.R.L. Peptide compounds having a nitrogenous polycyclic structure
US5411942A (en) * 1989-12-07 1995-05-02 Carlbiotech Ltd. A/S Peptide derivative, pharmaceutical preparation containing it and method for treatment of glaucoma
US5559209A (en) * 1993-02-18 1996-09-24 The General Hospital Corporation Regulator regions of G proteins
US6472172B1 (en) * 1998-07-31 2002-10-29 Schering Aktiengesellschaft DNA encoding a novel human inhibitor-of-apoptosis protein
US6608026B1 (en) * 2000-08-23 2003-08-19 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Apoptotic compounds
US7041784B2 (en) * 2000-08-23 2006-05-09 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Apoptotic compounds
US20020177557A1 (en) * 2000-09-29 2002-11-28 Yigong Shi Compositions and method for regulating apoptosis
US6992063B2 (en) * 2000-09-29 2006-01-31 The Trustees Of Princeton University Compositions and method for regulating apoptosis
US20030157522A1 (en) * 2001-11-09 2003-08-21 Alain Boudreault Methods and reagents for peptide-BIR interaction screens
US20060052311A1 (en) * 2002-07-02 2006-03-09 Sharma Sushil K Peptide inhibitors of smac protein binding to inhibitor of apoptosis proteins (IAP)
US20040171554A1 (en) * 2003-02-07 2004-09-02 Genentech, Inc. Compositions and methods for enhancing apoptosis
US20050214802A1 (en) * 2003-11-13 2005-09-29 Genentech, Inc. Compositions and methods for the screening pro-apoptotic compounds
US20050234042A1 (en) * 2004-04-07 2005-10-20 Palermo Mark G Organic compounds

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20110150827A1 (en) * 2009-12-18 2011-06-23 Idenix Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 5,5-fused arylene or heteroarylene hepatitis c virus inhibitors
US8362068B2 (en) 2009-12-18 2013-01-29 Idenix Pharmaceuticals, Inc. 5,5-fused arylene or heteroarylene hepatitis C virus inhibitors
US9187496B2 (en) 2009-12-18 2015-11-17 Idenix Pharmaceuticals Llc 5,5-fused arylene or heteroarylene hepatitis C virus inhibitors

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
JP2012184230A (en) 2012-09-27
NO339157B1 (en) 2016-11-14
DK1836201T3 (en) 2010-12-06
CA2588921C (en) 2015-10-20
US9040706B2 (en) 2015-05-26
ATE477254T1 (en) 2010-08-15
DK1836201T4 (en) 2013-11-11
JP5007235B2 (en) 2012-08-22
HK1109155A1 (en) 2008-05-30
CA2588921A1 (en) 2006-06-29
NO20073783L (en) 2007-09-19
MX2007007195A (en) 2007-10-08
US8609845B2 (en) 2013-12-17
EA019420B1 (en) 2014-03-31
EP1836201A1 (en) 2007-09-26
AU2005319305A1 (en) 2006-06-29
IL183514A (en) 2015-11-30
EP1836201B2 (en) 2013-09-04
IL183514A0 (en) 2007-09-20
EA200701467A1 (en) 2007-12-28
ES2349110T3 (en) 2010-12-28
US20060167066A1 (en) 2006-07-27
US20090318409A1 (en) 2009-12-24
ZA200704910B (en) 2008-09-25
WO2006069063A1 (en) 2006-06-29
ES2349110T5 (en) 2013-11-27
CN101146803A (en) 2008-03-19
NZ589670A (en) 2013-01-25
JP2008524333A (en) 2008-07-10
US20140080805A1 (en) 2014-03-20
DE602005022936D1 (en) 2010-09-23
AU2005319305B2 (en) 2012-08-23
EP1836201B1 (en) 2010-08-11
KR101278732B1 (en) 2013-07-09
KR20120127754A (en) 2012-11-23
KR20070089174A (en) 2007-08-30

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9040706B2 (en) Pyrrolidine inhibitors of IAP
US8247557B2 (en) IAP inhibitors
US8063218B2 (en) Imidazopyridine inhibitors of IAP
US8907092B2 (en) Inhibitors of IAP
US7244851B2 (en) Inhibitors of IAP
US7345081B2 (en) Azabicyclo-octane inhibitors of IAP
US20110218211A1 (en) Azaindole inhibitors of iap
US20110046066A1 (en) Inhibitors of iap

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION